Digital HD
Video Cassette Recorder
Operating Instructions
P
E
Model AJ-
Thank you for purchasing this product.
Before operating this product, please read the instructions carefully and save this manual for future use.
VQT0E88
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
For your safety
For U.S.A. and Canada
CAUTION
FCC Note:
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules.
To assure continued compliance follow the attached
installation instructions and do not make any
unauthorized modifications.
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK
DO NOT OPEN
CAUTION: TO REDUCE THE RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK,
DO NOT REMOVE COVER (OR BACK).
NO USER SERVICEABLE PARTS INSIDE.
REFER TO SERVICING TO QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL.
This equipment has been tested and found to comply
with the limits for a class A digital device, pursuant to
Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed
to provide reasonable protection against harmful
interference when the equipment is operated in a
commercial environment. This equipment generates,
uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if
not installed and used in accordance with the
instruction manual, may cause harmful interference
to radio communications. Operation of this equipment
in a residential area is likely to cause harmful
interference in which case the user will be required to
correct the interference at his own expense.
The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol,
within an equilateral triangle, is intended to
alert the user to the presence of uninsulated
“dangerous voltage” within the product’s
enclosure that may be of sufficient
magnitude to constitute a risk of electric
shock to persons.
The exclamation point within an equilateral
triangle is intended to alert the user to the
presence of important operating and
maintenance (service) instructions in the
literature accompanying the appliance.
CAUTION:
This apparatus can be operated at a voltage in the
range of 100 – 240 V AC.
Voltage other than 120 V is not intended for U.S.A.
and Canada.
Notice (U.S.A. only):
This product has a fluorescent lamp that contains
a small amount of mercury. It also contains lead
in some components. Disposal of these materials
may be regulated in your community due to
environmental considerations. For disposal or
recycling information please contact your local
authorities, or the Electronics Industries Alliance:
<http://www.eiae.org.>
CAUTION:
Operation at a voltage other than 120 V AC may
require the use of a different AC plug. Please contact
either a local or foreign Panasonic authorized service
center for assistance in selecting an alternate AC
plug.
For Europe
CAUTION:
DO NOT REMOVE PANEL COVER BY UN-
SCREWING
To reduce the risk of electric shock, do not remove
cover. No user serviceable parts inside.
indicates safety information.
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
For your safety
Caution for AC Mains Lead
FOR YOUR SAFETY PLEASE READ THE FOLLOWING TEXT CAREFULLY.
This product is equipped with 2 types of AC mains cable. One is for continental Europe, etc. and the other one is only
for U.K.
Appropriate mains cable must be used in each local area, since the other type of mains cable is not suitable.
FOR CONTINENTAL EUROPE, ETC.
FOR U.K. ONLY
Not to be used in the U.K.
If the plug supplied is not suitable for your socket
outlet, it should be cut off and appropriate one fitted.
As the colours of the wires in the mains lead of this
appliance may not correspond with the coloured
markings identifying the terminals in your plug, proceed
as follows:
FOR U.K. ONLY
This appliance is supplied with a moulded three pin
mains plug for your safety and convenience.
A 13 amp fuse is fitted in this plug.
Should the fuse need to be replaced please ensure that
the replacement fuse has a rating of 13 amps and that it
is approved by ASTA or BSI to BS1362.
Check for the ASTA mark Ï or the BSI mark Ì on the
body of the fuse.
•
The wire which is coloured GREEN-AND-YELLOW
must be connected to the terminal in the plug which
is marked with the letter E or by the Earth symbol Ó
or coloured GREEN or GREEN-AND-YELLOW.
The wire which is coloured BLUE must be connected
to the terminal in the plug which is marked with the
letter N or coloured BLACK.
•
•
If the plug contains a removable fuse cover you must
ensure that it is refitted when the fuse is replaced.
If you lose the fuse cover the plug must not be used
until a replacement cover is obtained.
The wire which is coloured BROWN must be
connected to the terminal in the plug which is marked
with the letter L or coloured RED.
A replacement fuse cover can be purchased from your
local Panasonic Dealer.
How to replace the fuse
1. Open the fuse compartment with a screwdriver.
IF THE FITTED MOULDED PLUG IS UNSUITABLE
FOR THE SOCKET OUTLET IN YOUR HOME THEN
THE FUSE SHOULD BE REMOVED AND THE PLUG
CUT OFF AND DISPOSED OF SAFELY. THERE IS A
DANGER OF SEVERE ELECTRICAL SHOCK IF THE
CUT OFF PLUG IS INSERTED INTO ANY 13 AMP
SOCKET.
If a new plug is to be fitted please observe the wiring
code as shown below.
2. Replace the fuse.
If in any doubt please consult a qualified electrician.
WARNING: THIS APPLIANCE MUST BE EARTHED.
IMPORTANT: The wires in this mains lead are coloured
in accordance with the following code:
Fuse
Green-and-Yellow:
Blue:
Brown:
Earth
Neutral
Live
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Contents
For your safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2
General outline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6
Standard accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7
Parts and Their Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8
ASSEMBLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58
INSERT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .59
SETUP MENU/SYSTEM MENU . . . . . . . . . . .60
FILE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .62
PF1/PF2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .64
CARD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
50P IN/OUT ASSIGN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
Front panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8
Time code display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16
Rear panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18
O
O
O
System menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78
Setup menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81
Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20
Example of connections performed for
one VTR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20
Example of connections performed for
two VTRs (deck-to-deck) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20
Example of system connections in
23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD) mode . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
Example of system connections in
25 Hz (SD) mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
Example of connections with an
editing controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
O
O
O
O
O
BASIC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81
OPERATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84
INTERFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87
EDIT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88
TAPE PROTECT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90
TIME CODE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91
VIDEO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93
AUDIO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
MENU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
Connections with Dolby-E components . . . . .104
How to switch the system frequency . . . . . . .105
Selecting the recording/playback format
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
Concerning tapes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23
Turning on the power and inserting
the cassette . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24
STOP and STANDBY modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24
Recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25
Playback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .26
Jog/shuttle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27
Manual editing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .28
Preroll . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .28
Automatic editing (deck-to-deck) . . . . . . . . . . . . .29
and sync signals which support the
operation mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105
Menu management accompanying
O
switching the system frequency . . . . . . . . . . .106
Time code and user’s bit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111
Time code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111
User’s bit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111
Setting the internal time code . . . . . . . . . . . .111
Setting the external time code . . . . . . . . . . . .112
Cue time registration, preroll and cue-up
(These functions work only on the HOME,
PF1 and PF2 screens.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112
Time code and user’s bit playback . . . . . . . .112
O
O
O
O
O
Switch settings and adjustments . . . . . . . . . . .29
Selecting the editing mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30
Registering the edit points . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30
Checking the edit points . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
Modifying edit points . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
Previewing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32
Automatic editing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32
Reviewing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
Superimpose screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113
Selecting the audio recording channels and
monitor output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .114
Display saving function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .115
Rack mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116
Video head cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .117
Condensation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .117
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .117
Error messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118
Audio split editing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34
Variable memory function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36
Function menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .38
General description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .38
Allocating the function keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
How to switch the settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
HOME . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
DIAG menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118
Warning messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .120
Error messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .120
O
O
O
VIDEO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47
AUDIO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .49
TC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .51
CUE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .52
DIAG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55
MENU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .57
RS-232C interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .122
Connector signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128
Printed circuit boards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .129
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
General outline
The model AJ-HD1700 is a DVCPRO HD-LP format
HD digital video cassette recorder which uses 1/4˝
wide compact cassette tapes.
It can record, play back and edit 1080/59.94i (60i),
720/59.94p (60p) and 1080/50i HD signals and also
play back existing DVCPRO (25 Mbps or 50 Mbps)
tapes.
By mobilizing highly efficient digital compression
technology to assure a high picture quality, this VTR
significantly minimizes deterioration in the picture
quality and sound quality during the dubbing process.
It features a compact size of 4U and a lightweight
design that enables it to be carried around with ease,
and to be readily installed in a 19-inch rack.
It is also capable of converting from sources with a
720/24p over 60p (720/25p over 60p) format recorded
using a variable frame rate camera into a 1080/24psf
(1080/25psf) format and outputting the resulting
signals, thus fulfilling the needs of applications in the
cinema film production field.
The equipment is set up using an interactive system
whereby the operator manipulates the function
buttons on the front panel and observes the menu
screens on the front panel’s LED monitor.
In terms of the editing features, this VTR is capable of
both assemble editing and insert editing.
Further, the HD-SD conversion facility of its format
converter, which is provided as a standard accessory,
extends the uses of this VTR to encompass
interfacing with existing SD systems and into
configuring of HD systems.
Standard accessories
Power cord (AJ-HD1700P) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1
Power cord (AJ-HD1700E) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2
6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Features
Compact size and light weight
Time codes
This is a 4U digital VTR. Using the rack-mounting adapters
(AJ-MA75P: optional accessory), it can also be easily
housed in a 19-inch rack.
This VTR comes with a built-in time code generator
(TCG)/time code reader (TCR).
In addition to the internal time code, an external time code
can also be input and recorded as the LTC on the VTR.
Up to 126 minutes of recording
Multi-functional interfaces
Using the DVCPRO HD-LP recording system, up to 126
minutes of material can be recorded on the newly developed
1/4˝ XL-size cassette tape.
•
Serial digital input/output connector
The VTR comes with an HD component serial interface
input/output connector. This one BNC connector enables
HD component video signals and 8-channels digital audio
signals to be interfaced. (SMPTE 292M, 299M, BTA S-
004)
High picture quality
The VTR’s high picture quality is achieved by 4:2:2 HD
component signal recording using a recording rate (100
Mbps) which is 4 times higher than that of the existing
DVCPRO format.
It is also equipped with an HD/SD format converter as a
standard accessory so that SD component serial signals
can also be output. (SMPTE 259M-C, 272M-A, 294M)
Analog video output connector
1080i/720p (*1), 59.94 Hz/60 Hz/50 Hz signal
switching
By making menu selections, the signals of the respective
formats can be recorded and played back.
•
Composite signals are output during DVCPRO50- or
DVCPRO-compatible playback, DV playback, DVCAM
playback and down-conversion.
•
•
AES/EBU audio input/output connectors
Digital audio input/output connectors for 8 channels are
featured as a standard accessory.
*1: When the system frequency of 50 Hz has been selected,
recording and playback using the 720p format are not possible.
SDTI input/output connector
Frame rate conversion function
Use of the SDTI board (optional accessory) enables
interfacing with the compressed component signals still in
their original form. (SMPTE 305M, 321M)
By making menu selections, the VTR can output signals
after converting them to the 1080/24psf (25psf) format when
it plays back a tape recorded by a variable frame rate
camera at a frame rate of 24fps (25fps).
•
•
SD signal up-conversion and recording
Using the input up-converter board (optional accessory),
SD component serial signals (SMPTE 259M-C) can be
up-converted and recorded as HD signals.
9-pin RS-422A and RS-232C remote control
connectors
SDI interface
The VTR comes with an HD serial digital interface as a
standard accessory.
In addition to the standard 9-pin serial remote (RS-422A)
control connector, the VTR is provided with RS-232C and
50-pin parallel remote control connectors.
The RS-422A facility enables parallel operation if a loop
connection has been established between the VTR and
another VTR.
Playback compatibility with DVCPRO systems
Besides DVCPRO HD-LP recording and playback, the VTR
can also play back tapes which have been recorded using
the existing DVCPRO HD, DVCPRO50 and DVCPRO
systems.
Consumer-use DV tapes (SP) and DVCAM tapes can also
be played back on this VTR.
8-channel high-sound-quality digital audio
The 8-channel PCM audio feature allows for not only
independent editing but mixing as well on all 8 channels.
One channel is provided for the analog cue track.
Digital slow motion/dial jog
Panasonic’s unique digital slow motion technology enables
clear playback (of tapes recorded using the DVCPRO HD-
LP system) at speeds ranging from j1k to i2k.
<Note>
Some noise may occur during slow playback (using an
external controller) at speeds of almost exactly j1k or
i2k.
Menu-driven setup
The setup settings, which are conducted prior to operating
the VTR, are performed while the operator views the setup
menus either on the VTR’s LCD monitor or on a TV monitor.
Multi-functional front panel with LCD monitor
The front panel’s multiple functions, including the LCD
monitor for monitoring images, the function buttons and
large-size display panel, are contained within the 4U
dimensions and designed to improve operating ease.
Search speed
Search speed enables tapes (recorded using the HD-LP
system) to be played back with color images at speeds of up
to 100 times in the forward or reverse direction.
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Parts and Their Functions
Front panel
5 1 67
2
3
4
3Cassette insertion slot
If the slot’s orange plate is visible, it means that a
cassette tape is already inserted.
EJECT
XL/L/M
Do not insert S-cassette
without adapter
-
cassette
POWER OFF
ON
CH1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CUE
REMOTE
CH CONDITION
MONITOR FULL/FINE
R
9P50P
RS-232C
L
HEADPHONES
SHTL
REV
JOG
VAR
ADJUST
PUSH-INTER
HOME
RF1
TC
RF2
CUE
ASSEM
INSERT
4EJECT button
VIDEO UNITY
FWD
AUDIO UNITY DIAG
MENU
When this button is pressed, the cassette is
unloaded, and a few seconds later it is ejected
automatically.
STAND BY PLAYER RECORDER INPUT CHECK
SHIFT
F1
DEF
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SERVO
PLAY
REC INHIBIT
REC
ABC
GHI
9
EDIT
REW
AUDIO CH SELECT
CH CH CH
A
IN
A
OUT
7
JKL
8
PREVIEW/
REVIEW
PRE-
ROLL
CH
1
CH
5
CH
2
CH
6
CH
3
7
4
8
MNO PQRS
4
5
6
3
T
BS
ENT
F
AUTO
EDIT
TUV WXYZ
TRIM
SET
STOPFF
1
0
2
PUSH
LOCK
IN
OUT
C
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
FULL
FULL
When CTL appears on the counter display, the
display is reset.
1POWER switch
5Headphones jack
The sound heard during recording, playback or
editing can be monitored through headphones
when stereo headphones are connected to this
jack.
2Audio level meter
The audio information is displayed here.
• The levels of the CH1, CH2, CH3, CH4, CH5,
CH6, CH7 and CH8 PCM audio signals and level
of the CUE track signal are displayed here.
• The levels of the input signals are displayed
during recording and when E-E is selected.
During playback, the levels of the playback
signals are displayed. In the INPUT CHECK
status, the levels of the input signals are
displayed for CH1 to CH8.
• Input signal display for each of the channels
The indicators for the selected input signals light.
(SDI lights when the SD SDI input signal is
selected.)
6Volume control dial
This control dial is used to adjust the volume level
of the headphones and monitor output.
Whether the volume level of the monitor output is to
be coupled together with that of the headphones to
this dial or separated can be selected using the
setup menu item No.712 (MONI OUT). (Note that
the volume level of the headphones is coupled at all
times.) When the volume levels have been
separated, the UNITY value (prescribed value)
applies to the monitor output.
If an input signal has been selected but it has not
actually been input,the AES, HDSDI, SDI or
SDTI indicator will blink if a signal corresponding
to one of these indicators was selected whereas
the ANA indicator will remain lighted if it was an
ANA signal that was selected.
7Channel condition lamps
These lamps light to indicate the error rate
status.
(Green “ amber “ red)
Green: This lights when the error rates for the
video and audio playback signals are both at
acceptable levels.
When the internal signal (INT SG) has been
selected, all the AES, ANA, HDSDI, SDI and
SDTI indicators light.
Amber: This lights when the error rate for either the
video or audio playback signals has deteriorated.
The playback picture and sound remain
unaffected even while this lamp is lighted.
Red: This lights when correction or interpolation
has been engaged for either the video or audio
playback signals.
All the indicator are off in the 23/24 Hz mode or
25 Hz (HD or SD) mode.
Input signal display
AES ANA
AES ANA
HD SDI SDTI
HD SDI SDTI
dB
0
dB
Level meter
-
-
4
8
•4
•3
•2
•1
0
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
•16
•12
•8
Reference level (j18 dB)
(AJ-HD1700E)
-
-
-
-
-
-
12
16
20
25
30
40
•4
Reference level (j20 dB)
(AJ-HD1700P)
0
-
-
-
-
1
2
3
4
-
-
-
-
5
10
20
-
L R
L R
Left (L) and right (R)
monitor channel displays
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Parts and Their Functions
:REMOTE buttons and RS-232C display
These buttons are used when this VTR is to be
controlled from an external component using the
REMOTE, RS-232C or parallel connector.
Front panel
<
8
9 :
=
;
EJECT
9P: When this button is pressed for 2 or more
seconds, its LED lights, and the 9-pin REMOTE
connector is selected.
XL/L/M-cassette
Do not insert S-cassette
without adapter
POWER OFF
ON
CH1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CUE
REMOTE
CH CONDITION
MONITOR FULL/FINE
R
9P50P
RS-232C
L
HEADPHONES
SHTL
REV
JOG
VAR
ADJUST
PUSH-INTER
HOME
RF1
TC
RF2
CUE
ASSEM
INSERT
VIDEO UNITY
FWD
AUDIO UNITY DIAG
MENU
50P: When this button is pressed for 2 or more
seconds, its LED lights, and it is possible to control
the VTR from a unit which has been connected using
the 50-pin parallel mode connector.
STAND BY PLAYER RECORDER INPUT CHECK
SHIFT
F1
DEF
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SERVO
PLAY
REC INHIBIT
REC
ABC
GHI
9
EDIT
REW
AUDIO CH SELECT
CH CH CH
A
IN
A
OUT
7
JKL
8
PREVIEW/
REVIEW
PRE-
ROLL
CH
1
CH
5
CH
2
CH
6
CH
3
7
4
8
MNO PQRS
4
5
6
3
T
BS
ENT
F
AUTO
EDIT
TUV WXYZ
TRIM
SET
STOPFF
1
0
2
PUSH
LOCK
IN
OUT
C
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
FULL
FULL
RS-232C display: This LED lights when communi-
cation has been enabled between the VTR and the
unit which has been connected to the RS-232C
connector.
8MONITOR SELECT buttons
These buttons are used to select the audio signals
which are to be output to the monitor L and R
connectors and headphones jack.
;AUTO OFF lamp
• When OFF has been selected as the
M
F6
This lamp lights when a problem has occurred with
the VTR’s operation, and details of the problem
appear on the time code display.
MIX setting on the <AUDIO SHIFT2> menu
(factory setting):
Each time the L (or R) button is pressed, the
signal to be output to the monitor L (or R)
connector is changed in the following sequence
and displayed on the audio level meter: CH1 >
CH2 > CH3> CH4 > CH5 > CH6 > CH7 >
CH8 > CUE > CH1, etc.
<LCD monitor
This monitor is used to check the tape’s playback
pictures and EE pictures.
When an HD tape is played back, the signals are down-
converted and displayed in the letter-box screen format.
When an SD tape is played back, the signals are
displayed using a 4:3 aspect ratio.
•
When L, R or L/R has been selected as the
M MIX setting on the <AUDIO SHIFT2> menu:
F6
At this setting, the signals of a multiple number of
channels can be mixed and output.
When the number key corresponding to the
channel whose signals are to be monitored is
pressed while the L (or R) button is held down,
that channel is selected and its signals are
On-screen menus can also be displayed on the monitor.
If the VTR is left in a state where no controls on the front
panel are operated or where the tape is not running, the
monitor display is automatically turned off in order to
protect the monitor. When the next VTR operation is
started, the monitor display comes back on.
displayed on the audio level meter.
(By
<Note>
performing the same operation, the selected
channel can be de-selected.)
Although the LCD monitor has been manufactured
using technology with extremely high levels of
precision, some pixels may be missing from parts of
the screen or some pixels may remain lighted.
These missing or lighted pixels will not be recorded.
It should also be borne in mind that this is not
indicative of a malfunction.
However, a maximum of only two channels from
CH1 to CH4 and a maximum of only two
channels from CH5 to CH8 can be selected.
Example of channels which can be selected:
CH1 i CH3 i CH5 iCH8 “ OK
CH1 + CH2 + CH4 “ NG
=Function buttons
9METER (FULL/FINE) selector button
These buttons are used to perform the operations of
the function menus (see page 38 for details) and
setup menus.
This button is used to select the scale display for the
audio level meter.
: This is used to switch the pages of the current
SHIFT
FULL mode: Depending on the setting selected for the
setup menu item No.763 (METER SCALE)*, either the
j¶ to 0 dB (reference level: j20 dB/j18 dB**) or j¶
to i20 dB (reference level: 0 dB) range is displayed.
FINE mode: Depending on the setting selected for the
setup menu item No.763 (METER SCALE)*, either the
j24 to j15 dB (reference level: j20 dB/j18 dB**) or
j4 to i5 dB (reference level: 0 dB) range is displayed
on a scale with 0.5 dB increments.
function menu ( to ).
F1
F6
to
: These are used to change the settings of
F6
the setting items enclosed in the frame at the bottom of
the time code display.
F1
To change a setting, keep pressing the corresponding
function button (
to
) until the desired
F1
F6
numerical value appears; alternatively, press the
corresponding function button to highlight the setting of
the setting item, and then turn the ADJUST dial until
the desired numerical value is obtained.
9
*
This menu is not displayed for AJ-HD1700E.
** j20 dB is applied for AJ-HD1700P and j18 dB is for AJ-HD1700E.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Parts and Their Functions
Front panel
>
@ A C
CUE: This enables up to 60 cue points to be set. In
the PAGE mode, 10 pages with 6 cue points on
each page are provided so that the cue points can
be managed on a page-by-page basis.
DIAG: This enables the warnings and hour meter
displays to be checked. On the SHIFT screen, the
error log files can be checked and deleted.
MENU: On this menu, it is possible to transfer
operation to the screen on which operations
(adjustments and saving data in or loading it from
the internal memory and IC card) relating to the
SYSTEM and SETUP menus are to be performed.
EJECT
XL/L/M-cassette
Do not insert S-cassette
without adapter
POWER OFF
ON
CH1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CUE
REMOTE
CH CONDITION
MONITOR FULL/FINE
R
9P50P
RS-232C
L
HEADPHONES
SHTL
REV
JOG
VAR
ADJUST
PUSH-INTER
HOME
RF1
TC
RF2
CUE
ASSEM
INSERT
VIDEO UNITY
FWD
AUDIO UNITY DIAG
MENU
STAND BY PLAYER RECORDER INPUT CHECK
SHIFT
F1
DEF
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SERVO
PLAY
REC INHIBIT
REC
ABC
GHI
9
EDIT
REW
AUDIO CH SELECT
CH CH CH
A
IN
A
OUT
7
8
PREVIEW/
REVIEW
PRE-
ROLL
CH
1
CH
5
CH
2
CH
6
CH
3
7
4
8
JKL
MNO PQRS
4
5
6
3
T
BS
ENT
F
AUTO
EDIT
TUV WXYZ
TRIM
SET
STOPFF
1
0
2
PUSH
LOCK
IN
OUT
C
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
FULL
FULL
? B
>Time code display
The data, VTR status information, tape format
information or warning information which
corresponds to the direct menu buttons @ appear
on this display. (See page 16 for details of the
displays.)
See page 38 and following for further details on
each of the function menus.
AASSEM button
This button is used to perform assemble editing.
When it is pressed, the <ASSEMBLE> menu
appears on the time code display. Setting ASSEM
?UNITY lamps
VIDEO UNITY lamp
to ON using
lamp of the ASSEM button lights.
enables assemble editing, and the
F1
This lights if the UNITY level applies for all the HD
or SD output levels.
Even after operation is transferred by another direct
menu, the assemble mode will remain established
while the ASSEM button lamp is lighted.
AUDIO UNITY lamp
This lights if the UNITY level applies for the PCM
or CUE AUDIO input or output level. (The lighting
of the lamp complies with the setting selected for
setup menu item No.142 (AUDIO UNITY).)
To release the assemble mode, select OFF as the
ASSEM setting on the <ASSEMBLE> menu.
F1
The ASSEM button lamp now goes off and the
assemble mode is released.
@Direct menu buttons
These buttons are used to switch directly to the
function menus on the time code display.
HOME: The most basic settings of recording,
playback and time code operations are selected
on this menu.
VIDEO: The basic input and output settings for the
video signals are selected on this menu. The
level of the HD output signals can also be
adjusted on this screen.
AUDIO: The basic input and output settings for the
audio signals are selected on this menu.
PF1: This enables user-defined menu items to be
registered in the function keys.
BINSERT button
This button is used to perform insert editing.
When it is pressed, the <INSERT> menu appears
on the time code display, and the function menu for
selecting the signals to be edited is displayed.
To select the signals to be edited, press the
function key, and highlight the display. The
highlighted display indicates that those signals are
selected.
To release the selection, press the same function
key again.
Use
to
to select the V, A1, A2, A3, A4 and
F6
F1
CUE signals; use
A5, A6, A7, A8 and TC signals.
+
to
to select the
F6
SHIFT
F2
PF2: This enables user-defined menu items to be
registered in the function keys.
TC: The settings related to the time code are
selected on this menu. Superimposing the time
code on the display can also be set on this
screen.
CADJUST dial
This is used for the menu and other operations.
10
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Parts and Their Functions
Front panel
HD E F
HREV, STILL and FWD lamps
EJECT
XL/L/M-cassette
Do not insert S-cassette
without adapter
These lamps light to reflect the way in which the
search dial is operated.
POWER OFF
ON
CH1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CUE
REMOTE
CH CONDITION
MONITOR FULL/FINE
R
9P50P
RS-232C
L
HEADPHONES
REV: This lights when the dial is turned
counterclockwise, and the tape runs in the REV
direction while the SHTL, JOG or VAR button
lamp is lighted.
STILL: While the JOG button lamp is lighted, this
lights when the dial rotation is stopped, and the
tape also stops running.
SHTL
REV
JOG
VAR
ADJUST
PUSH-INTER
HOME
RF1
TC
RF2
CUE
ASSEM
INSERT
VIDEO UNITY
FWD
AUDIO UNITY DIAG
MENU
STAND BY PLAYER RECORDER INPUT CHECK
SHIFT
F1
DEF
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SERVO
PLAY
REC INHIBIT
REC
ABC
GHI
9
EDIT
REW
AUDIO CH SELECT
CH CH CH
A
IN
A
OUT
7
JKL
8
PREVIEW/
REVIEW
PRE-
ROLL
CH
1
CH
5
CH
2
CH
6
CH
3
7
4
8
MNO PQRS
4
5
6
3
T
BS
ENT
F
AUTO
EDIT
TUV WXYZ
TRIM
SET
STOPFF
1
0
2
PUSH
LOCK
IN
OUT
C
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
FULL
FULL
I
J
G
In the SHTL or VAR mode, it lights when the dial
is at the still-picture position.
DSHTL button
FWD: This lights when the dial is turned clockwise,
and the tape runs in the FWD direction while the
SHTL, JOG or VAR button lamp is lighted.
For shuttle playback, press this button and proceed
with the operation using the search dial G.
When the dial is turned to the desired position, the
tape is played at the speed corresponding to the
angle to which the dial has been turned. A still
picture appears when the dial is set to the center
position.
IAudio input and output level control dials
These are used to adjust the recording or playback
levels of the CH1, CH2, CH3, CH4, CH5, CH6, CH7
and CH8 PCM audio signals.
EJOG button
• Switching between the LOCK or UNLOCK
status for the volume level operations
For jog playback, press this button and proceed
with the operation using the search dial G.
The tape is played at a speed within the speed
range set using setup menu items No.310 (JOG
FWD MAX) and No.311 (JOG REV MAX) in
accordance with the speed at which the dial is
turned.
When a dial is pressed, the LED above the dial
either lights (LOCK) or goes off (UNLOCK).
In the LOCK (lighted) status, only the display
segments corresponding to the current audio
level light, and the audio level remains
unchanged even when the dial is turned.
In the UNLOCK (off) status, the display
segments corresponding to the current audio
level and all the display segments below light,
and the audio level can be changed.
FVAR button
For VAR playback, press this button and proceed
with the operation using the search dial G.
When the dial is turned all the way in the
counterclockwise direction, the tape speed is set to
j4.9k, when it is set to the center position, it is set
to still picture, and when it is turned all the way in
the clockwise direction, it is set to i4.9k.
The SLOW speed can be selected using setup
menu items No.308 (VAR FWD MAX) and No.309
(VAR REV MAX).
• Switching between UNITY or VAR
UNITY or VAR can be selected when the dial
knob is pressed while holding down the
key
F
among the number keys in the UNLOCK status.
The position of the segment lighted at the center
indicates the UNITY level.
• Switching between REC or PB
The AUTO, REC or PB volume level function can
be selected using
of “AUDIO SHIFT2” on the
F1
GSearch dial
AUDIO function menu.
With AUTO, the recording controls are
automatically selected during recording or in the
EE or INPUT CHECK status, and the playback
controls are automatically selected during
playback.
This dial is used to locate the edit points.
Whether the dial is to be enabled by pressing the
SHTL, JOG or VAR button or whether searches are
to be enabled simply by turning the dial can be
selected using setup menu item No.100 (SEARCH
ENA).
j
j
• Switching between CH1 CH4 and CH5 CH8
The AUDIO CH SELECT J is used to switch
between these two sets of channels.
11
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Parts and Their Functions
Front panel
LN
NPREROLL button
This button is used to locate where a transmission
or manual editing starts on the tape.
When it is pressed, the tape travels to the preroll
point and it stops there.
EJECT
XL/L/M-cassette
Do not insert S-cassette
without adapter
POWER OFF
ON
CH1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CUE
REMOTE
CH CONDITION
MONITOR FULL/FINE
R
9P50P
RS-232C
L
HEADPHONES
SHTL
REV
JOG
VAR
ADJUST
PUSH-INTER
HOME
RF1
TC
RF2
CUE
ASSEM
INSERT
VIDEO UNITY
FWD
AUDIO UNITY DIAG
MENU
When the cue time has been registered on the
HOME, PF1 or PF2 screen:
The tape is prerolled from the registered cue time
STAND BY PLAYER RECORDER INPUT CHECK
SHIFT
F1
DEF
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SERVO
PLAY
REC INHIBIT
REC
ABC
GHI
9
EDIT
REW
AUDIO CH SELECT
CH CH CH
A
IN
A
OUT
7
JKL
8
PREVIEW/
REVIEW
PRE-
ROLL
CH
1
CH
5
CH
2
CH
6
CH
3
7
4
8
MNO PQRS
4
5
6
3
T
BS
ENT
F
AUTO
EDIT
TUV WXYZ
TRIM
SET
STOPFF
1
0
2
PUSH
LOCK
IN
OUT
C
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
FULL
FULL
using the preroll time which was set using .
F1
(PREROL) on the <HOME SHIFT> menu.
J K
M
O
When the search mode is established on the
CUE screen:
The tape is prerolled from the selected cue point
JAudio channel selector button
Use this button to select whether the audio controls
for channels CH1 to CH4 or for channels CH5 to
CH8 are to be controlled.
Each time it is pressed, the channel display LED
above the audio control is selected.
using the preroll time which was set using
(CU-ROL) on the <CUE SHIFT> menu.
The preroll operation is not performed when the
selected cue point has not been registered or
when the cue point registration mode is
established.
F5
KNumber keys
In all other situations:
Use these keys to input the numerical values of the
CUE points, edit points, etc.
The tape is prerolled from the registered IN point
(or the current tape position when the IN point has
not been registered) using the preroll time which
By pressing a number keys from
to
while the
1
9
key is held down, alphabet letters from A to F
F
was set using [
(PREROL) on the <HOME
F1
which are used for the user’s bit or letters from A to
Z which are used to compose filenames can be
input.
Since a multiple number of letters are allocated to
each number key, keep tapping the number key
until the desired letter is selected. To change the
input position, use the ADJUST dial, and then
proceed with the input.
SHIFT> menu.
If the PREROLL button is pressed when the IN
point has not been registered, the current tape
position is automatically registered as the IN point
(but only when ENA has been selected as the
setup menu item No.305 (AUTO ENTRY) setting).
When the PREROLL button is pressed together
with the IN (A IN) or OUT (A OUT) button, the tape
can be cued up to the registered point concerned.
To cue up the tape for the cue time registered on
the HOME, PF1 or PF2 screen, press the
PREROLL button while holding down the
among the number keys.
LPREVIEW/REVIEW button
PREVIEW: When the button is pressed after an edit
point has been registered, the tape travels and the
editing can be previewed without actually
performing the editing.
key
F
If the button is pressed when the IN point has not
been registered, the point where it was pressed is
registered as the IN point, and preview is
executed using this IN point.
REVIEW: When the button is pressed after a
section has been edited, the just edited section is
played back, and it can be reviewed on the
recorder’s monitor.
OIN (A IN), SET and OUT (A OUT) buttons
When the IN (A IN) or OUT (A OUT) button is pressed
together with the SET button, the IN (A IN) or OUT (A
OUT) point is registered.The A IN and A OUT buttons
are used to register audio IN and OUT points that
differ from the corresponding video points during
audio split editing.
When an IN (A IN) or OUT (A OUT) point has been
registered, the lamp of the IN (A IN) or OUT (A OUT)
button which has registered that point lights. When
these buttons are pressed after points have been
registered, the IN (A IN) or OUT (A OUT) point value
appears on the counter display.
MAUTO EDIT button
When this button is pressed after the edit points
have been registered, automatic editing is initiated.
If the button is pressed when the IN point has not
been registered, automatic editing is initiated with
the point where the button was pressed serving as
the IN point.
When the
button is pressed while holding down the
C
IN (A IN) or OUT (A OUT) button, the registration of
the IN (A IN) or OUT (A OUT) point is cleared.
12
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Parts and Their Functions
Front panel
P
T W X
When the STOP button is pressed, the original picture
and sound are restored.
During playback, search, fast forwarding or rewinding, the
input signals in the mode selected by the <ASSEMBLE>
menu or <INSERT> menu can be monitored in the E-E
mode while the button is held down.
EJECT
XL/L/M-cassette
Do not insert S-cassette
without adapter
POWER OFF
ON
CH1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CUE
REMOTE
CH CONDITION
MONITOR FULL/FINE
R
9P50P
RS-232C
L
HEADPHONES
SHTL
REV
JOG
VAR
ADJUST
PUSH-INTER
HOME
RF1
TC
RF2
CUE
ASSEM
INSERT
VIDEO UNITY
FWD
AUDIO UNITY DIAG
MENU
STAND BY PLAYER RECORDER INPUT CHECK
SHIFT
F1
DEF
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
<Note>
SERVO
PLAY
REC INHIBIT
REC
ABC
GHI
9
EDIT
REW
AUDIO CH SELECT
CH CH CH
A
IN
A
OUT
7
JKL
8
PREVIEW/
REVIEW
PRE-
ROLL
CH
1
CH
5
CH
2
CH
6
CH
3
7
4
8
MNO PQRS
4
5
6
3
T
BS
ENT
F
No guarantees are made for the sound played back in the
search mode.
AUTO
EDIT
TUV WXYZ
TRIM
SET
STOPFF
1
0
2
PUSH
LOCK
IN
OUT
C
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
FULL
FULL
Q R S V
U
U
PLAY button
Press this button to start playback.
When this button is pressed together with the REC
button, recording starts; when this button is pressed
together with the EDIT button during playback, manual
editing starts.
However, manual editing will not be initiated if the servo
is not locked. When only the PLAY button is pressed
during manual editing, editing is exited, and the playback
mode is established.
P TRIM buttons
These buttons are used to make fine adjustments to the
IN or OUT point.
By pressing the i or j button while the IN button or OUT
button is held down, the registered edit point can be
adjusted in 1-frame increments. When the i button is
pressed, the point is moved ahead by one frame;
conversely, when the j button is pressed, it is moved
back by one frame.
V
W
X
REC button
The playback phase can be adjusted by pressing the i
or j button while holding down the PLAY button.
When this button is pressed together with the PLAY
button, recording starts.
Q REW button
SERVO lamp
When this button is pressed, the tape is rewound.
The rewinding speed can be selected using setup menu
item No.102 (FF.REW MAX).
This lamp lights when the drum servo or capstan servo
locks.
REC INHIBIT lamp
This lights or goes off in accordance with the status of the
accidental erasure prevention tab on the cassette tape
R STOP button
When this button is pressed, the tape stops traveling, and
if TAPE is selected as the
OUTPUT setting on the
F1
and the setting which has been selected for
REC
F6
<HOME> menu, still pictures can be monitored.
Even in the stop mode, the drum continues to rotate, and
the tape remains tightly wound around the drum.
Therefore, when the VTR is left in the stop mode beyond
a specific period of time, it is automatically set to the
standby OFF mode in order to protect the tape. The VTR
is set to the stop mode immediately after the cassette has
been installed.
INH on the <HOME> menu. Recording onto the tape is
inhibited while the lamp is lighted.
Cassette tape’s
accidental erasure
prevention tab status
REC INH
menu setting
REC INHIBIT
lamp status
Description of
operation
Lighted*
(or blinks slowly).
Recording
disabled
All recording operations
are inhibited.
__
OFF
ALL
All recording operations
are permitted.
Off
S FF button
All recording operations
are inhibited.
Lighted
When this button is pressed, the tape is fast forwarded.
The fast forwarding speed can be selected using setup
menu item No.102 (FF.REW MAX).
Recording operations
involving the overwriting
of existing material are
inhibited.
PREBlinks
rapidly
Recording
enabled
T EDIT button
This button is pressed together with the PLAY button
during playback to initiate manual editing.
When the button is pressed in the stop mode, the input
signals in the mode selected by the <ASSEMBLE> menu
or <INSERT> menu can be monitored in the E-E mode.
Normal recording
operations are inhibited.
Editing is possible.
NORM
V/CTL
Blinks rapidly
Blinks rapidly
Recording of video
signals and CTL signals
are inhibited.
* Whether the REC INHIBIT lamp is to light or blink is selected by
the No.114 REC INH LAMP setup menu item setting.
13
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Parts and Their Functions
Front panel
Y Z [
ZPLAYER and RECORDER buttons
These buttons are operated if the VTR is to be used
as a recorder to conduct editing operations with a
VTR equipped with an RS-422A serial interface
remote control connector (9 pins). Neither button
works when the VTR is used on its own.
PLAYER: When this button is pressed, its lamp
lights to indicate that the player connected to the
VTR can be operated by remote control. The
VTR’s editing and tape transport system buttons
can now be used to control the player.
EJECT
XL/L/M-cassette
Do not insert S-cassette
without adapter
POWER OFF
ON
CH1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CUE
REMOTE
CH CONDITION
MONITOR FULL/FINE
R
9P50P
RS-232C
L
HEADPHONES
SHTL
REV
JOG
VAR
ADJUST
PUSH-INTER
HOME
RF1
TC
RF2
CUE
ASSEM
INSERT
VIDEO UNITY
FWD
AUDIO UNITY DIAG
MENU
STAND BY PLAYER RECORDER INPUT CHECK
SHIFT
F1
DEF
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SERVO
PLAY
REC INHIBIT
REC
ABC
GHI
9
EDIT
REW
AUDIO CH SELECT
CH CH CH
A
IN
A
OUT
7
8
PREVIEW/
REVIEW
PRE-
ROLL
CH
1
CH
5
CH
2
CH
6
CH
3
7
4
8
JKL
MNO PQRS
4
5
6
3
T
BS
ENT
F
AUTO
EDIT
TUV WXYZ
TRIM
SET
STOPFF
1
0
2
PUSH
LOCK
IN
OUT
C
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
FULL
FULL
RECORDER: When this button is pressed, its lamp
lights to indicate that the editing and tape
transport system buttons can now be used to
operate the recorder (this VTR).
YSTANDBY button
The same tape tension is applied as in the regular
stop mode. While the head drum is rotating, the
button’s lamp lights to indicate that the standby ON
mode is now established.
• When the PLAYER button or RECORDER button
is pressed while ENA has been selected as the
setup menu item No.200 (PARA RUN) setting,
the lamps of both buttons light to indicate that the
VTR now serves as the master unit for parallel
run operations. However, when this setting is
used, it is no longer possible to perform external
control from the REMOTE connector (9 pins).
If the button is pressed in the stop mode, the
standby OFF mode is established followed by the
half loading mode. At this time, its lamp goes off.
When the VTR is left in the stop mode beyond a
specific period of time, it is automatically set to the
standby OFF mode in order to protect the tape.
In the standby OFF mode, if this button or the
STOP button is pressed, the VTR is set to the
standby ON mode. If a button other than the
STOP button is pressed, the VTR is set to the
mode that corresponds to the button pressed.
The time taken by the VTR to transfer to the
standby OFF mode can be selected using a setup
menu item.
[INPUT CHECK button
Only while this button is held down are the input
signals from the monitor output connector output to
enable the input video and audio signals to be
monitored.
The time code generator can be checked on the
time code display.
Select LATCH as the setup menu item No.517
(TCG OUT) setting in order to continue displaying
the time code generator value even after the INPUT
CHECK button has been released.
<Note>
The INPUT CHECK function does not work for the
CUE signal and SDTI signals. Input signals can be
monitored in the E-E mode.
14
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Parts and Their Functions
Front panel
INPUT CHECK output specifications
VIDEO (59/60 Hz mode)
Input selection
AUDIO
MONITOR (L, R) selection
INT SG
(59.94Hz/
60Hz)
HD SDI
(59.94Hz/
60Hz)
Output system
(MENU 600)
SD SDI
SDTI
CH1 to CH8
CUE
(59.94Hz)
(59.94 Hz)
Audio input which has been
set by the channels selected
as L channels*2
Output system
Same as main
system*1
MONITOR L
HD SDI
(MONITOR)
(59.94Hz/60Hz)
INT SG
(selected
signal)
HD SDI
(input signal)
MUTE
(BLACK)
Same as
main system*
Audio input which has been
set by the channels selected
as R channels*2
Same as main
system*1
MONITOR R
SD SDI
(MONITOR)
(59.94Hz)
MUTE
(BLACK)
MUTE
(BLACK)
SD SDI
(input signal)
Same as
main system*
Audio input which has been
set by the channels selected
as L channels*2
Same as main
system*1
HEAD PHONE L
HEAD PHONE R
LCD
(MONITOR)
(59.94Hz/60Hz)
INT SG
(selected
signal)
HD SDI
(input signal)
SD SDI
(input signal)
Same as
main system*
Audio input which has been
set by the channels selected
as R channels*2
Same as main
system*1
VIDEO OUT3
(59.94Hz)
Same as
Same as
Same as
Same as
main system* main system* main system* main system*
HD SDI (MONITOR)
(embedded audio)
Same as main system*1*3
SD SDI (MONITOR)
(embedded audio)
Same as main system*1*3
VIDEO (50 Hz mode)
Input selection
(MENU 600)
*1: The INPUT CHECK operation is not performed. The signals
corresponding to the VTR operation mode are output.
*2: This is set using setup menu items No.713 to 724. However,
the INPUT CHECK operation is not performed when video
input SDTI is selected.
INT SG
(50Hz)
HD SDI
(50Hz)
SD SDI
(50Hz)
Output system
HD SDI
(MONITOR)
(50Hz)
INT SG
(selected
signal)
HD SDI
(input signal)
MUTE
(BLACK)
*3: Noise may occur if the video input and OUTREF signals are
not synchronized.
SD SDI
(MONITOR)
(50Hz)
MUTE
(BLACK)
MUTE
(BLACK)
SD SDI
(input signal)
LCD
(MONITOR)
(50Hz)
INT SG
(selected
signal)
HD SDI
(input signal)
SD SDI
(input signal)
VIDEO OUT3
(50Hz)
Same as
Same as
Same as
main system* main system* main system*
<Notes>
• The AJ-UC1700G (optional accessory) is required to
select the SD SDI input signals.
• The AJ-YAC150P (optional accessory) is required to
select the SDTI input signals.
• When the INT SG input signal is selected, the signals are
selected by menu item No.601.
• When the 23/24 Hz mode or 25 Hz (HD or SD) mode is
selected, the INPUT CHECK operation is not performed.
* When the SDTI input is selected, the INPUT CHECK operation is
not performed.
15
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Parts and Their Functions
Time code display
1
2
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
EDIT:
1Cue time display
Editing mode
AUTO EDIT:
Automatic editing mode
PREVIEW:
Preview mode
REVIEW:
The currently registered cue time appears here.
(For details of the cue time operations, refer to “Cue
time registration, preroll and cue-up” on page 112.)
Cue time operations can be performed on the
HOME, PF1 and PF2 screens only.
Review mode
2Operation mode (speed) display
The current operation mode (including the speed
display) appears here.
EJECT:
F6
• When “ON” has been selected as the [F]
(VARMEM) setting on the <HOME SHIFT>
menu:
Eject mode
j
i
DSPD (speeds from 1.0 to 2.0)
With the initial speed setting of the variable
memory
STANDBY OFF:
Standby OFF mode
T.RELEASE:
Tension release mode
STOP:
j
i
DSMP (speeds from 1.0 to 2.0)
In the playback speed memory mode of the
variable memory
Stop mode
j
i
DPLY (speeds from 1.0 to 2.0)
PREROLL:
In the variable memory playback mode
Preroll mode
PLAY:
j
i
DPRV (speeds from 1.0 to 2.0)
In the variable memory editing preview mode
Playback mode
j
i
DEDT (speeds from 1.0 to 2.0)
i
PLAY :
In the variable memory editing execution mode
Special playback (playback phase adjustment)
mode (in FWD direction)
j
PLAY :
Special playback (playback phase adjustment)
mode (in REV direction)
REC:
Recording mode
JOG (REV/STILL/FWD):
Jog mode
j
k
i
k
VAR (speeds from 4.9 to 4.9 ):
Variable mode
j
k
i
k
SHTL (speeds from 32. to 32.0 ):
Shuttle mode
FF:
Fast forwarding mode
REW:
Rewinding mode
16
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Parts and Their Functions
Time code display
3
6
4
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
5
3Time counter display
4Variable memory mode indicator
CTL:
TCG:
UBG:
tcg:
CTL counter data
This is displayed when “ON” has been selected as
the
(VARMEM) setting on the <HOME SHIFT>
F6
Time code data of time code generator
User’s bit data of time code generator
When the time code data of the time
code generator is preset
When the user’s bit data of the time
code generator is preset
menu.
While VM is lighted, variable memory operations
can be performed at any time. (For details, refer to
the “Variable memory function” on page 36.)
ubg:
¢
5
TCR/T R: Time code data of the time code reader
Back page menu indicator
¢
UBR/U R: User’s bit data of the time code reader
6Function button operation inhibited indicator
This is displayed when the button is pressed
BS
If the time code data or user’s bit data could not be
read properly, “T¢R” or “U¢R” appears on the
display and, if the CTL signal is present, the time
code data is supplemented by this signal.
while the
button is held down. When it appears,
F
the operation of the function buttons can be
inhibited. When the button is pressed again
BS
while the
button is held down, the display is
F
TCR 00 : 00 : 00 : 00.
(59/60 Hz mode only)
cleared, and it becomes possible to operate the
function buttons.
Drop frame marks:
“ : ”: Non-drop frame
“ . ”: Drop frame
Field marks
“
”: 1st field
“ . ”: 2nd field
(These marks are not displayed at any
speed above w0.3k.)
17
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Parts and Their Functions
Rear panel
8
6 5 7 9
=
8CUE OUT connector
4
<
4
The analog signals recorded on the CUE tracks are
output through this connector.
IN
OUT
1
OUT
2
OUT
3
MONITOR (SUPER)
CH7·8
TC
CUE
IN
MON
L
HD SDI
PUSH
PUSH
IN
ACTIVE
THROUGH
SDTI
SD SDI AUDIO CH1·2
IN
CH3·4
CH3·4
CH5·6
CH5·6
OUT
OUT
R
IN
(OPTION)
9MONITOR OUT connectors
AUDIO
OUT
CH1·2
CH7·8
OUT
4
MONITOR
(SUPER)
The CH1, CH2, CH3, CH4, CH5, CH6, CH7 and
CH8 PCM audio signals or CUE signals are output
through these connectors.
DIGITAL AUDIO
ANALOG
AUDIO IN
CH
CH
1
1
CH
CH
2
2
CH
3
CH
CH
PUSH
PUSH
PUSH
PUSH
VIDEO OUT SD REF IN
HD REF IN
HD REF OUT
1
PARALLEL
ON
ON
ENCODER
REMOTE
AC IN
AUDIO OUT
CH
75≠
75≠
REMOTE
IN/OUT
2
3
(WFM)
(SUPER)
3
4
PUSH
PUSH
PUSH
OFF
OFF
SD
REF OUT
REMOTE
OUT
R
E
M
O
T
RS-232C
SIGN
G
L
D
E
:ANALOG AUDIO IN connectors
These are the analog audio input connectors (for
CH1, CH2, CH3 and CH4).
2 1
3
;
:
1AC IN socket
;ANALOG AUDIO OUT connectors
Using the power cord supplied, connect one end to
this socket and the other end to the power outlet.
The analog audio signals (CH1, CH2, CH3 and
CH4) are output through these connectors.
2SIGNAL GND terminal
<
HD SERIAL DIGITAL COMPONENT AUDIO/VIDEO
IN/OUT connector/ACTIVE THRU
The HD digital component audio and video signals
complying with the SMPTE 292M and 299M
standards are input and output through this
connector.
This is connected to the signal ground terminal on
the component connected to this VTR in order to
minimize noise. It is not a safety ground.
3Fuse holder
A fuse is inserted here.
Signals with the time code, menu or other
superimposed information are output from the HD
SDI MONITOR.
4Fan
The fan is used to cool down the VTR.
If the fan has been stopped due to some kind of
problem, “W” appears on the time code display and
a beeping sound is heard.
If the VTR is made to continue operating in the
warning status, the temperature inside the deck
rises, and when it exceeds the safety temperature,
all the VTR’s operations will be shut down.
For INPUT CHECK, refer to the INPUT CHECK
output table on page 15.
=SDTI IN and OUT connectors (SDTI, optional
accessory)*1, SD SDI IN/ACTIVE THRU (SD up-
converter, optional accessory)*2
*1: These connectors handle compressed data
input and output signals complying with the
SMPTE 305M and 321M standards.
5TIME CODE IN connector
*2: These input connectors enable SD SDI signals
complying with the SMPTE 259M-C standard to
be up-converted to HD signals and recorded.
This connector is used to record an external time
code onto the tape.
6TIME CODE OUT connector
<Notes>
During playback, the playback time code is output
through this connector. During recording, the time
code generated by the internal time code generator
is output.
• The optional AJ-UC1700G SD serial digital input
board and optional AJ-YAC150P SDTI input
board cannot be installed at the same time.
Install one or the other.
• SDTI does not function when the 25 Hz (HD or
SD) or 50 Hz mode has been selected as the
system menu item No.25 (SYSTEM FREQ)
setting.
7CUE IN connector
The analog signals to be recorded on the CUE
tracks are input through this connector.
Audio signals from a microphone can also be
recorded by selecting the j60 dB input mode for
setup menu item No.704 (CUE IN LV).
18
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Parts and Their Functions
Rear panel
>
D
B
H
The signals which can be switched using the menu items
are the TC, CTL, video, RF L/R and ENV L/R signals.
There is no INPUT CHECK function. The signals are
muted during line conversion.
IN
OUT
1
OUT
2
OUT
3
MONITOR (SUPER)
TC
CUE
IN
MON
L
HD SDI
PUSH
PUSH
IN
ACTIVE
THROUGH
SDTI
SD SDI AUDIO CH1·2
IN
CH3·4
CH3·4
CH5·6
CH5·6
CH7·8
CH7·8
OUT
OUT
R
IN
(OPTION)
AUDIO
OUT
CH1·2
OUT
4
MONITOR
(SUPER)
DIGITAL AUDIO
ANALOG
AUDIO IN
CH
CH
1
1
CH
CH
2
2
CH
3
CH
CH
PUSH
PUSH
PUSH
PUSH
VIDEO OUT SD REF IN
1
HD REF IN
HD REF OUT
@ SD REF IN connectors and 75-ohm termination
switches
PARALLEL
ON
ON
ENCODER
REMOTE
AC IN
AUDIO OUT
CH
75≠
75≠
REMOTE
IN/OUT
2
3
(WFM)
(SUPER)
3
4
OFF
OFF
SD
REF OUT
REMOTE
OUT
These are the SD reference video signal input
connectors. Input composite signal with color burst.
For termination, set the termination switch to ON.
R
E
M
O
T
RS-232C
SIGN
G
L
D
E
? @ A C G F
E
A HD REF IN connectors and 75-ohm termination
switches
>SD SERIAL DIGITAL COMPONENT AUDIO and
VIDEO OUT connectors
These are the HD reference video signal input
connectors. Input tri-level sync signals with both positive
and negative polarities.
The digital component audio and video signals
complying with the SMPTE 259M-C, 272M-A or
294M standard are output from these connectors.
They are output during DVCPRO25M, 50M, DV or
DVCAM interchangeable playback or when signals
are down-converted and output. Signals containing
TC, menu or other superimposed information can
be output from the SD SDI MONITOR.
Using setup menu item No.606 (SD MONI O SEL),
it is also possible to make the SD SDI MONITOR
output the same output as SD SDI OUT1 (no
information superimposed).
For termination, set the termination switch to ON.
B HD REF OUT connector
This is the HD reference video signal output connector for
external synchronization. Tri-level sync signals with both
positive and negative polarities are output.
The output based on SYS FORMAT of menu item No.020
is delivered from the connector.
C SD REF OUT connector
When “SD SDI” has been selected as the
(VID
F1
The composite signal used for external synchronization
(black burst signal) is output from this connector.
IN) setting on the <VIDEO> menu and “THRU” has
been selected as the No.107 (EE MODE SEL)
setting, no information is superimposed onto the SD
SDI MONITOR output signals in the EE mode, and
the same output as SD SDI OUT1 is delivered.
• The AJ-UC1700G optional board is required in
D DIGITAL AUDIO IN and OUT connectors
These are the input and output connectors of the digital
audio signals that comply with the AES/EBU standards.
order to select “SD SDI” as the
setting on the <VIDEO> menu.
• For INPUT CHECK, refer to the INPUT CHECK
output table on page 15. Note that the signals
are muted during line conversion.
(VID IN)
F1
E
Remote control connectors
These connectors make it possible to use two of these
VTRs or to connect this VTR to an external controller so
that this VTR can be operated from an external
component.
Two remote control connectors are provided: one for
IN/OUT uses and the other for OUT uses only.
IN/OUT:For connection with an external controller
For connection during deck-to-deck operations
OUT: For connection during parallel run operations
For loop-through uses
<Note>
In the 23/24 Hz mode, the system phase of the SD
SDI output and analog composite video output is
subject to change when the tape has been set to
travel at the normal speed (1k) so that the HD SDI
output and phase will be aligned.
?ANALOG COMPOSITE VIDEO OUT connectors
The analog composite video signals are output through
these connectors. They are output during DVCPRO25M,
50M, DV or DVCAM interchangeable playback or when
signals are down-converted and output.
F
ENCODER REMOTE connector
An external encoder remote controller is connected to
this connector when the video output signal settings are
to be adjusted from an external component.
Video signals containing superimposed information can
be output through the VIDEO OUT 3 connector. Whether
the superimposing is to be set ON or OFF is selected
using the setup menu item No.005 (SUPER).
The waveform monitor (WFM) signal can be output from
the VIDEO OUT 2 connector.
G
H
RS-232C connector
PARALLEL REMOTE connector
This is used when the VTR is to be operated from an
external component.
19
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connections
Example of connections performed
for one VTR
Example of connections performed
for two VTRs (deck-to-deck)
Player side:
Source side:
Set the REMOTE LED : on the front panel to the off
status (LOCAL mode).
Press the “9P” REMOTE button on the front panel
for 2 or more seconds to set the VTR to the
REMOTE status. (The 9P LED lights.)
SDTI output (when SDTI, an optional
accessory, has been installed)
SD SDI input ACTIVE THRU (when SD
up-converter, an optional accessory, has
been installed)
Recorder side:
Set the REMOTE LED : on the front panel to the
off status (LOCAL mode).
SDTI input (when SDTI, an optional
accessory, has been installed)
SD SDI input (when SD up-converter,
an optional accessory, has been
installed)
SD reference signal generator
To audio monitor
cmponent
HD SDI signal
HD SDI input (audio, video)
Source side
HD SDI output
IN
OUT
1
OUT
2
OUT
3
MONITOR (SUPER)
CH7·8
TC
MON
L
HD SDI
PUSH
PUSH
IN
(ACTIVE THRU)
ACTIVE
THROUGH
SDTI
SD SDI AUDIO CH1·2
IN
CH3·4
CH3·4
CH5·6
CH5·6
OUT
R
IN
(OPTION)
SD SDI outputs
HD SDI outputs
Digital audio inputs
AUDIO
OUT
CH1·2
CH7·8
OUT
4
MONITOR
(SUPER)
DIGITAL AUDIO
ANALOG
AUDIO IN
CH
CH
CH
1
1
CH
CH
2
2
3
CH
CH
PUSH
PUSH
PUSH
PUSH
VIDEO OUT SD REF IN
HD REF IN
HD REF OUT
1
PARALLEL
ON
ON
ENCODER
REMOTE
AC IN
AUDIO OUT
CH
75≠
75≠
REMOTE
IN/OUT
2
3
(WFM)
(SUPER)
3
4
OFF
OFF
SD
REF OUT
Audio monitor outputs
Digital audio outputs
REMOTE
OUT
R
E
M
O
T
RS-232C
SIGN
G
L
D
E
IN
OUT
1
OUT
2
OUT
3
MONITOR (SUPER)
TC
CUE
IN
MON
L
HD SDI
PUSH
PUSH
IN
ACTIVE
THROUGH
SDTI
SD SDI AUDIO CH1·2
IN
CH3·4
CH3·4
CH5·6
CH5·6
CH7·8
To video monitor
component
OFF
OUT
OUT
R
IN
(OPTION)
AUDIO
OUT
CH1·2
CH7·8
OUT
4
MONITOR
(SUPER)
DIGITAL AUDIO
ANALOG
AUDIO IN
Remote
signal (9P)
CH
CH
1
1
CH
CH
2
2
CH
3
CH
CH
PUSH
PUSH
PUSH
PUSH
VIDEO OUT SD REF IN
1
HD REF IN
HD REF OUT
PARALLEL
ON
ON
ENCODER
REMOTE
AC IN
AUDIO OUT
CH
75≠
75≠
REMOTE
IN/OUT
2
3
(WFM)
(SUPER)
3
4
PUSH
OFF
OFF
To audio monitor
component
SD
REF OUT
REMOTE
OUT
R
E
M
O
T
RS-232C
SIGN
G
L
D
E
Recorder side
IN
OUT
1
OUT
2
OUT
3
MONITOR (SUPER)
CH7·8
TC
CUE
IN
MON
L
HD SDI
PUSH
PUSH
IN
ACTIVE
THROUGH
HD reference inputs
(loop-through output)
SDTI
SD SDI AUDIO CH1·2
IN
CH3·4
CH3·4
CH5·6
CH5·6
OUT
OUT
R
IN
(OPTION)
AUDIO
OUT
CH1·2
CH7·8
OUT
4
MONITOR
(SUPER)
SD reference inputs
(loop-through output)
DIGITAL AUDIO
ANALOG
AUDIO IN
CH
CH
1
1
CH
CH
2
2
CH
3
CH
CH
PUSH
PUSH
PUSH
PUSH
VIDEO OUT SD REF IN
1
HD REF IN
HD REF OUT
PARALLEL
ON
ON
ENCODER
REMOTE
AC IN
AUDIO OUT
CH
75≠
75≠
REMOTE
IN/OUT
2
3
(WFM)
(SUPER)
3
4
OFF
OFF
SD
REF OUT
Video monitor output
REMOTE
OUT
R
E
M
O
T
RS-232C
SIGN
G
L
D
(3 composite output lines)
E
Analog audio outputs
Analog audio inputs
To video monitor
component
ON
20
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connections
Example of system connections in
23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD) mode
Example of system connections in
25 Hz (SD) mode
When this VTR plays back a tape which was recorded at a frame rate of 24
fps (25 fps) using a variable frame rate camera, the signals on the tape can
be output after converting them to 1080/24psf (1080/25psf) to enable direct
editing together with the AJ-HD3700 series.
When this VTR plays back a tape which was recorded at a frame rate of 25
fps using a variable frame rate camera, the signals on the tape can be
output after converting them to 576/50i to enable direct editing together
with the SD VTRs.
Shown in the figure below is an example of the deck-to-deck connections.
Input the 48 Hz (or 50 Hz) reference signal to the HD REF input connector
as the REF input.
Shown in the figure below is an example of the deck-to-deck connections.
Input the 50 Hz reference signal to the SD REF input connector as the REF
input.
HD SDI OUT
AJ-HD1700
SD SDI OUT
AJ-HD1700
SD SDI signal
(Source side)
(Source side)
IN
OUT
1
OUT
2
OUT
3
MONITOR (SUPER)
CH7·8
TC
CUE
IN
MON
L
HD SDI
IN
OUT
1
OUT
2
OUT
3
MONITOR (SUPER)
CH7·8
PUSH
PUSH
TC
CUE
PUSH
MON
L
HD SDI
IN
PUSH
IN
IN
ACTIVE
THROUGH
ACTIVE
THROUGH
SDTI
SD SDI AUDIO CH1·2
IN
CH3·4
CH3·4
CH5·6
CH5·6
SDTI
SD SDI AUDIO CH1·2
IN
CH3·4
CH3·4
CH5·6
CH5·6
OUT
OUT
R
OUT
OUT
R
IN
(OPTION)
IN
(OPTION)
AUDIO
OUT
CH1·2
CH7·8
AUDIO
OUT
CH1·2
CH7·8
OUT
4
MONITOR
(SUPER)
OUT
4
MONITOR
(SUPER)
DIGITAL AUDIO
ANALOG
AUDIO IN
DIGITAL AUDIO
ANALOG
AUDIO IN
CH
CH
1
1
CH
CH
2
2
CH
3
CH
CH
PUSH
PUSH
PUSH
PUSH
CH
CH
1
1
CH
CH
2
2
CH
3
CH
CH
PUSH
PUSH
PUSH
PUSH
VIDEO OUT SD REF IN
1
HD REF IN
HD REF OUT
VIDEO OUT SD REF IN
1
HD REF IN
HD REF OUT
PARALLEL
PARALLEL
ON
ON
ENCODER
REMOTE
ON
ON
ENCODER
REMOTE
AC IN
AUDIO OUT
CH
75≠
75≠
REMOTE
IN/OUT
2
3
(WFM)
(SUPER)
AC IN
AUDIO OUT
CH
75≠
75≠
REMOTE
3
4
2
3
(WFM)
(SUPER)
3
4
IN/OUT
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
SD
REF OUT
SD
REMOTE
OUT
REF OUT
REMOTE
OUT
R
E
M
O
T
RS-232C
R
E
M
O
T
SIGN
G
L
D
RS-232C
SIGN
G
L
D
E
E
™
75
™
REMOTE
IN/OUT
75
REMOTE
IN/OUT
Reference signal
termina-
tion OFF
termination
OFF
Reference signal
For 24 Hz mode:HD REF 48 Hz (interlace)
SD REF 50 Hz (interlace)
For 25 Hz (HD) mode:HD REF 50Hz (interlace)
HD SDI signal
Remote
signal (9P)
SD SDI
signal
REMOTE
IN/OUT
HD SDI
IN
™
75 termination ON
SD SDI
IN
Remote
AJ-SD955A
(Recorder side)
AJ-HD3700
(Recorder side)
signal (9P)
AES/EBU
ANALOG
REMOTE
ANALOG
CH1/2
VIDEO
IN
IN
SDI
OUT
AC IN
REF IN
HD
VIDEO OUT
2
WFM
SD SDI
OUT1
HD SDI
O1UT
IN
REMOTE IN/OUT
PUSH
PUSH
PUSH
PUSH
PUSH TC
CH1
CH3
CH1
CH3
AUDIO
IN
CH2
CH4
CH2
CH4
1
3
IN
IN
OUT
3
ON
SD
ON
IN
~AC IN
Y
P
75
1•2 3•4
CH3/4
IN
ON
1
2
3
OFF
(
)
SUPER
ACTIVE
ACTIVE
75™
75™
THROUGH
THROUGH
O2UT
CH
CH
1•2 3•4
CH
CH
5•6 7•8
REMOTE
OUT
INPUT
OUT2
OFF
SD
OFF
ACTIVE
THROUGH
TC
B
OUT
CH1/2
OUT
REF VIDEO
IN
MONITOR
(
)
SUPER
SPARE
MONITOR
HD
SD
ENCODER REMOTE
RS-232C
CH
CH
1•2 3•4
CH CH
5•6 7•8
OUTPUT
ON
P
75
R
CH3/4
OUT
OPTION
OFF
(SUPER)
(
)
AUDIO
OUT
MON
L
SUPER
REF OUT
DIGITAL AUDIO
OPTION
SDTI
Y
1
VIDEO
OUT
REMOTE
IN
REMOTE
OUT
REMOTE
IN/OUT
V/A
RS-232C
CONTROL
IN
OUT
PARALLEL
IN/OUT
PARALLEL
(
)
50P
MON
R
CONTROL
PANEL
1
2
2
P
B
(WFM)
AUDIO IN
PUSHH
TIME CODE
PUSHN
3
P
R
(SUPER)
PUSHH
1
PUSH
2
3
PUSHH
4
PUSH
5
OUT
SIGNAL
GND
SERVICE ONLY
AUDIO OUT
CH
MONITOR
CH
1
CH
2
3
CH
4
CUE
L
R
SIGNAL
GND
™
75 termination ON
REMOTE
OUT
Video monitor
Video monitor
Note concerning tapes played back by this VTR
•
Use tapes which have been shot by a variable frame rate
<Notes>
camera.
•
When the tape begins to travel at 1k speed, the video may be
disturbed and the audio muted for several frames in order to
synchronize the REF input with the tape.
VITC signals are not output to the SD SDI and VIDEO OUT
connectors in the 23/24 Hz mode.
In the 25 (HD) Hz mode, the output video signals of the SD SDI
and VIDEO OUT connectors are delayed by approximately 1 field
in relation to the HD SDI output.
•
Do not use tapes which are copies of shot tapes or edited tapes.
Doing so will cause the tape management information to be lost,
and normal conversion and playback may not be possible as a
result.
To convert a tape, which was recorded at a frame rate other than
24fps (25fps), to 1080/24psf (1080/25psf), use a frame rate
converter (AJ-FRC27) which is available as an optional
accessory.
•
•
•
•
HD SDI output is muted in the 25 (SD) Hz mode.
21
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connections
Example of connections with an editing controller
Recorder
EJECT
AV monitor
XL/L/M-cassette
Do not insert S-cassette
without adapter
POWER OFF
ON
Video monitor signals
CH1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CUE
REMOTE
CH CONDITION
MONITOR FULL/FINE
R
9P50P
RS-232C
L
HEADPHONES
SHTL
REV
JOG
VAR
ADJUST
PUSH-INTER
HOME
RF1
TC
RF2
CUE
ASSEM
INSERT
VIDEO UNITY
FWD
AUDIO UNITY DIAG
MENU
STAND BY PLAYER RECORDER INPUT CHECK
SHIFT
F1
DEF
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SERVO
PLAY
REC INHIBIT
REC
ABC
GHI
9
EDIT
REW
AUDIO CH SELECT
CH CH CH
A
IN
A
OUT
7
JKL
8
PREVIEW/
REVIEW
PRE-
ROLL
CH
1
CH
5
CH
2
CH
6
CH
3
7
4
8
Audio monitor
signals
MNO PQRS
4
5
6
3
T
BS
ENT
F
AUTO
EDIT
TUV WXYZ
TRIM
SET
STOPFF
1
0
2
PUSH
LOCK
IN
OUT
C
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
FULL
FULL
To REMOTE IN/OUT
connector
Av monitor
Editing controller
Reference signal
generator
AV switcher
Remote signals
To
To REMOTE IN/OUT
connector
REMOTE
IN/OUT
EJECT
EJECT
XL/L/M
Do not insert S-cassette
without adapter
-
cassette
XL/L/M-cassette
Do not insert S-cassette
without adapter
POWER OFF
ON
POWER OFF
ON
CH1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CUE
CH1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CUE
REMOTE
REMOTE
CH CONDITION
MONITOR FULL/FINE
R
CH CONDITION
MONITOR FULL/FINE
R
9P50P
RS-232C
9P50P
RS-232C
L
L
HEADPHONES
HEADPHONES
SHTL
REV
JOG
VAR
SHTL
REV
JOG
VAR
ADJUST
PUSH-INTER
ADJUST
PUSH-INTER
HOME
RF1
TC
RF2
CUE
ASSEM
INSERT
HOME
RF1
TC
RF2
CUE
ASSEM
INSERT
VIDEO UNITY
VIDEO UNITY
FWD
FWD
AUDIO UNITY DIAG
MENU
AUDIO UNITY DIAG
MENU
STAND BY PLAYER RECORDER INPUT CHECK
STAND BY PLAYER RECORDER INPUT CHECK
SHIFT
F1
DEF
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SHIFT
F1
DEF
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SERVO
PLAY
REC INHIBIT
REC
SERVO
PLAY
REC INHIBIT
REC
ABC
GHI
9
ABC
GHI
9
EDIT
REW
EDIT
REW
AUDIO CH SELECT
CH CH CH
A
IN
A
OUT
AUDIO CH SELECT
CH CH CH
A
IN
A
OUT
7
JKL
8
7
JKL
8
PREVIEW/
REVIEW
PRE-
ROLL
PREVIEW/
REVIEW
PRE-
ROLL
CH
1
CH
5
CH
2
CH
6
CH
3
7
4
8
CH
1
CH
5
CH
2
CH
6
CH
3
7
4
8
MNO PQRS
MNO PQRS
Reference signal
4
5
6
3
T
BS
ENT
F
4
5
6
3
T
BS
ENT
F
AUTO
EDIT
AUTO
EDIT
TUV WXYZ
TUV WXYZ
TRIM
SET
TRIM
SET
STOPFF
STOPFF
1
0
2
1
0
2
PUSH
LOCK
PUSH
LOCK
IN
OUT
IN
OUT
C
C
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
FULL
FULL
FULL
FULL
Source unit
Source unit
Av monitor
Av monitor
<Note>
When disconnecting the remote signals (9P) from one component
and re-connecting them to another component, check the settings,
etc. of the editing controller.
22
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Concerning tapes
Consumer-use DV and DVCAM
cassettes
EJECT
XL/L/M-cassette
Do not insert S-cassette
without adapter
POWER OFF
ON
S cassettes
CH1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CUE
REMOTE
CH CONDITION
MONITOR FULL/FINE
R
9P50P
RS-232C
L
These tapes are exclusively designed for
consumer-use DV and DVCAM camera recorders.
They can be played using a cassette adapter
(optional accessory).
However, bear in mind that long-duration
cassette tapes (80 minutes in the standard
mode and 120 minutes in the LP mode) cannot
be used.
HEADPHONES
SHTL
REV
JOG
VAR
ADJUST
PUSH-INTER
HOME
RF1
TC
RF2
CUE
ASSEM
INSERT
VIDEO UNITY
FWD
AUDIO UNITY DIAG
MENU
STAND BY PLAYER RECORDER INPUT CHECK
SHIFT
F1
DEF
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SERVO
PLAY
REC INHIBIT
REC
ABC
GHI
9
EDIT
REW
AUDIO CH SELECT
CH CH CH
A
IN
A
OUT
7
JKL
8
PREVIEW/
REVIEW
PRE-
ROLL
CH
1
CH
5
CH
2
CH
6
CH
3
7
4
8
MNO PQRS
4
5
6
3
T
BS
ENT
F
AUTO
EDIT
TUV WXYZ
TRIM
SET
STOPFF
1
0
2
PUSH
LOCK
IN
OUT
C
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
FULL
FULL
It is recommended that tapes bearing the
Panasonic brand be used as the consumer-use DV
tapes.
• Bear in mind that inserting a cassette tape
without the use of a cassette adapter will cause
malfunctioning.
M cassette size
L cassette size
M cassettes
DVCPRO HD LP:
Tapes capable of up to 32 minutes of recording and
playback
DVCPRO 25/50/50P/HD playback tapes
XL cassette size
L cassettes
DVCPRO HD LP:
Tapes capable of up to 92 minutes of recording and
playback
Align the cassette with the center of the insertion slot,
and push it in gently.
DVCPRO 25/50/50P/HD playback tapes
For consumer-use DV or DVCAM applications:
These are playback tapes in the standard
consumer-use DV or DVCAM cassettes.
It is recommended that tapes bearing the
Panasonic brand be used as the consumer-use DV
tapes.
The cassette tape will be loaded automatically.
<Precautions when playing back consumer-use
DV and DVCAM tapes>
• It is not possible to play back consumer-use tapes
which have been recorded in the LP mode.
• The maximum transport speed of a consumer-use
DV or DVCAM cassette tape is 32k.
• The maximum still time for a consumer-use DV or
DVCAM cassette tape is 10 seconds.
XL cassettes
DVCPRO HD LP:
• From the perspective of protecting consumer-use
DV and DVCAM cassette tapes, minimize the
number of times the tapes are cued up at the
same place as far as possible.
Tapes capable of up to 126 minutes of recording
and playback
• When consumer-use DV and DVCAM cassette
tapes are used, the maximum time for STILL
TIMER is set to 10 seconds and the total time
elapsing when the VTR is left standing in the
STILL mode is set to 1 minute.
• When editing material which has been recorded
onto a consumer-use DV or DVCAM cassette
tape, first record the material onto a DVCPRO HD
tape or another VTR used for broadcasting
applications.
• Noise may occur when performing slow playback
using consumer-use DV or DVCAM cassette
tapes.
23
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Turning on the power and inserting the cassette
Before starting to operate the VTR, check whether the
equipment has been connected properly.
1
3
2
Turn on the VTR’s power.
1
2
EJECT
XL/L/M-cassette
Do not insert S-cassette
without adapter
POWER OFF
ON
Check that the AUTO OFF lamp is off.
CH1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CUE
REMOTE
CH CONDITION
MONITOR FULL/FINE
R
9P50P
RS-232C
L
If condensation or some other problem has
occurred, the AUTO OFF lamp lights, and no
further operations can be performed.
HEADPHONES
SHTL
REV
JOG
VAR
ADJUST
PUSH-INTER
HOME
RF1
TC
RF2
CUE
ASSEM
INSERT
VIDEO UNITY
FWD
AUDIO UNITY DIAG
MENU
STAND BY PLAYER RECORDER INPUT CHECK
SHIFT
F1
DEF
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SERVO
PLAY
REC INHIBIT
REC
ABC
GHI
9
EDIT
REW
AUDIO CH SELECT
CH CH CH
A
IN
A
OUT
7
JKL
8
PREVIEW/
REVIEW
PRE-
ROLL
CH
1
CH
5
CH
2
CH
6
CH
3
7
4
8
MNO PQRS
4
5
6
3
T
BS
ENT
F
AUTO
EDIT
TUV WXYZ
Insert the cassette tape.
Without forcing it, insert the cassette tape at the
prescribed position.
TRIM
SET
STOPFF
3
4
1
0
2
PUSH
LOCK
IN
OUT
C
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
FULL
FULL
4
Check that the STOP lamp is lighted.
When the tape is inserted, the cylinder starts
rotating automatically, the tape is loaded, and the
VTR is set to the STOP mode. The EJECT lamp
goes off.
STOP and STANDBY modes
2
The VTR is set to the STOP mode when its STOP
button is pressed. The STOP lamp lights, and the
tape stops running.
1
EJECT
XL/L/M-cassette
Do not insert S-cassette
without adapter
POWER OFF
ON
CH1
CH CONDITION
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CUE
•
In order to protect the tape, the VTR is set to
standby OFF after the time set by setup menu
item No.400 (STILL TIMER) has elapsed. If the
STOP, REW, FF or PLAY button is now
pressed, the VTR will be set to the
corresponding mode.
REMOTE
MONITOR FULL/FINE
R
9P50P
RS-232C
L
HEADPHONES
SHTL
REV
JOG
VAR
ADJUST
HOME
RF1
TC
RF2
CUE
ASSEM
PUSH-INTER
VIDEO UNITY
INSERT
FWD
AUDIO UNITY DIAG
MENU
STAND BY PLAYER RECORDER INPUT CHECK
SHIFT
F1
DEF
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SERVO
PLAY
REC INHIBIT
REC
ABC
GHI
EDIT
REW
AUDIO CH SELECT
CH CH CH
A
IN
A
OUT
7
8
9
PREVIEW/
REVIEW
PRE-
ROLL
CH
1
CH
5
CH
2
CH
6
CH
3
7
4
8
JKL
MNO PQRS
4
5
6
3
T
BS
ENT
F
AUTO
EDIT
TUV WXYZ
TRIM
SET
STOPFF
1
0
2
PUSH
LOCK
IN
OUT
C
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
FULL
FULL
The VTR is set to the STANDBY ON/OFF mode
when its STANDBY button is pressed. The
standby ON mode is established while the button’s
lamp is lighted. When the button is pressed in the
standby OFF mode, the VTR is set to the standby
ON mode.
2
1
When the button is pressed while the VTR is in the
STOP mode, it is set to the standby OFF mode
and the half-loading status, and the button’s lamp
goes off.
<Precautions for STILL TIMER setting>
The cumulative total standby time at the same place
increases when programs are transmitted or the same
material is used repeatedly. In order to protect the
tape, keep the standby time at the same place on the
tape as short as possible by, for instance, selecting a
maximum of 30 seconds or so as the setup menu item
No.400 (STILL TIMER) setting.
24
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Recording
Set the accidental erasure prevention tab on the
cassette tape to the “recording” position, and insert
the tape.
Press the PLAY button while holding down the
REC button.
The REC and PLAY lamps light, and recording
starts.
1
6
7
Press the STOP button to set the VTR to the stop
mode.
2
When the STOP button is pressed, the recording
ends, and the VTR is set to the stop mode.
Select “EE” as the OUTPUT setting using
the <HOME> menu. E-E pictures now appear on
the TV monitor.
on
F1
3
4
<Notes>
•
During recording, check that the SERVO lamp is
lighted. The playback pictures will be disturbed if it
is blinking or off.
Check that the REC INHIBIT lamp is off.
If the lamp is lighted, select “OFF” as the R INH
•
If analog signals (ANA1 to ANA4) have been
selected as the CH5 to CH8 input signals on the
AUDIO menu, their recording levels are tied in with
the recording levels which have been set for the
CH1 to CH4 signals.
setting using
on the <HOME> menu.
F6
If the inserted cassette has already been recorded
on using a format other than DVCPRO HD-LP, the
recording inhibited status (factory setting) will be
set by setup menu item No.118.
•
When SDTI has been selected as the video signals
to be recorded, the audio signals which will be
recorded are also automatically set to SDTI.
Select the video and audio input signals, and
adjust the audio levels.
5
Selecting the video and audio input signals
1Connect the signals to be recorded.
2Select the input signals using
on the
on the
F1
F6
<VIDEO> menu and to
F1
<AUDIO> menu or <AUDIO SHIFT1> menu.
Adjust the audio levels
1Adjust the audio input levels of the CH1, CH2,
CH3, CH4, CH5, CH6, CH7, CH8 audio signals
and analog cue signal selected on the AUDIO
menu.
When the audio UNITY lamp on the front panel
is lighted, the audio signals will be recorded at
the appropriate levels.
2Before adjusting the recording level, check that
the REC LED is lighted and that the audio
adjustment dial is in the unlocked status (LOCK
LED off).
If the dial is in the LOCK status (LOCK LED
lighted), press it. The LOCK LED goes off, and
the lock is released.
In addition, the analog cue audio recording level
is adjusted using setup menu item No.790 (CUE
REC VOL) so that it will not exceed j20 dB.
25
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Playback
Playback phase adjustment function
Insert the cassette tape, and set the VTR to the
STOP mode.
1
If two VTRs are to be used to play the same program,
the playback phase between the VTRs can be
adjusted by changing the playback speed of one of
the VTRs.
Press the PLAY button.
Normal playback commences.
2
Adjust the audio playback levels.
Press the TRIM button (“i” or “j” button) while
3
1
Before adjusting the playback levels, check that
the PB LED is lighted and that the audio
adjustment dial is in the unlocked status. If the dial
is locked (indicated by the lighted LOCK LED),
press it. The LOCK LED goes off, and the lock is
released. The analog cue audio level is adjusted
using setup menu item No.791 (CUE PB VOL).
Normally, the VTR is kept in the UNITY status (the
segment display of the control lights at the center).
holding down the PLAY button. Each time it is
pressed, the playback speed is accelerated or
decelerated in increments of the number of
playback framing fields selected by the setup menu
item No.109 (CAP.LOCK) setting.
The SERVO lamp remains off while the tape is
being played at the accelerated or decelerated
speed.
Upon completion of the playback phase
adjustment, release the PLAY button.
The VTRs now return to the standard playback
speed, and the SERVO lamp lights.
2
To end the playback, press the STOP button. The
VTR is now set to the STOP mode.
4
<Note>
During playback, check that the SERVO lamp is
lighted. The playback pictures will be disturbed if the
lamp is off or blinking.
26
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Jog/Shuttle
Jog mode
Variable mode
Press the JOG button.
1
Press the VAR button.
1
Turn the search dial.
2
Turn the search dial.
The playback picture speed changes from j4.9k
to i4.9k depending on the dial position.
The maximum shuttle speed can be changed by
selecting the setup menu item No.308 (VAR FWD
MAX) and No.309 (VAR REV MAX) settings.
Noise will be generated at all speeds other than
j1k to i2k. (For all tapes other than DVCPRO
HD-LP recorded ones, the noise-free speed range
is j1.0k to i1.1k.)
2
The dial’s click-stops are released, and the tape is
played back at the speed corresponding to the
speed at which the dial is turned.
The maximum jog speed can be changed by
selecting the setup menu item No.310 (JOG FWD
MAX) and No.311 (JOG REV MAX) settings.
When the dial is no longer turned, a still picture will
appear.
To transfer the VTR from the jog mode to another
mode, press the button that corresponds to the
mode concerned.
3
To transfer the VTR from the variable mode to
another mode, press the STOP button or the
button of the mode concerned.
3
<Note>
Shuttle mode
At the factory setting, the VTR is set to be transferred
to the shuttle mode, jog mode or variable mode when
the search dial is turned.
In cases where it is not convenient for the VTR to be
transferred directly to the variable speed mode, it can
be transferred via the search button. Select “KEY” as
the setup menu item No.100 (SEARCH ENA) setting.
Press the SHTL button.
1
Turn the search dial.
2
The playback picture speed changes from 0 up to
w32k depending on the dial position.
This speed can be switched to w9.8k, w16k or
w32k using setup menu item No.101 (SHTL
MAX).
The dial has a click-stop at the center position
where a still picture will appear.
To transfer the VTR from the shuttle mode to
another mode, press the STOP button or the
button of the mode concerned.
3
27
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Manual Editing
Select the editing mode.
ASSEM button:
Assemble (frame-to-frame continuity) editing is
performed using this button.
INSERT button:
While monitoring the TV monitor, search the
position where the editing is to be started (IN
point), and press the PLAY and EDIT buttons
together at this position.
1
4
5
Insert editing is performed using this button.
Similarly, while monitoring the TV monitor, search
the position where the editing is to be terminated
(OUT point), and press the PLAY or STOP button
at this position. The VTR is set to the PLAY or
STOP mode, and the editing is terminated.
On the time code display, select the channels to be
edited.
ASSEM:
Set ASSEM to ON using the
2
button.
F1
INSERT:
To select V, A1, A2, A3, A4 and CUE channels,
press the to buttons; to select A5, A6, A7,
F1
F6
A8 and TC channels, press the
+
to
F2
SHIFT
+
buttons. The highlighted channels
F6
SHIFT
will now be edited.
Press the PLAY button.
3
Preroll
Press the PREROLL button.
The VTR now performs the preroll operation.
<Note>
1
The time code or CTL signal must be continuously
recorded between the edit IN point and preroll point.
When the cue time has been registered on the
HOME, PF1 or PF2 screen:
The tape is prerolled from the registered cue time
using the preroll time which was set using
F1
(PREROL) on the <HOME SHIFT> menu.
When the search mode is established on the
CUE screen:
The tape is prerolled from the selected cue point
using the preroll time which was set using
F5
(CU-ROL) on the <CUE SHIFT> menu.
The preroll operation is not performed when the
selected cue point has not been registered or when
the cue point registration mode is established.
In all other situations:
The tape is prerolled from the registered IN point
(or the current tape position when the IN point has
not been registered) using the preroll time which
was set using
(PREROL) on the <HOME
F1
SHIFT> menu.
If the PREROLL button is pressed when the IN
point has not been registered, the current tape
position is automatically registered as the IN point
(but only when ENA has been selected as the
setup menu item No.305 (AUTO ENTRY) setting).
28
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Automatic Editing (deck-to-deck)
“Editing” refers to the work involved in using pre-
recorded tapes to bring different contents together or
delete unnecessary parts and bring together only the
necessary parts.
Switch settings and adjustments
When using this VTR as the recorder
Set the VTR to the LOCAL status (which is
indicated when the REMOTE LED is OFF).
The basic editing steps are as follows.
Set the POWER
switch to ON.
Using the REMOTE button, set the player to
REMOTE and the recorder to LOCAL (ensure that
the REMOTE LED is not lighted).
1
EJECT
XL/L/M-cassette
Do not insert S-cassette
without adapter
POWER OFF
ON
CH1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CUE
REMOTE
CH CONDITION
MONITOR FULL/FINE
R
9P50P
RS-232C
L
HEADPHONES
Select the editing mode (ASSEM or INSERT).
2
SHTL
REV
JOG
VAR
ADJUST
PUSH-INTER
HOME
RF1
TC
RF2
CUE
ASSEM
INSERT
VIDEO UNITY
FWD
AUDIO UNITY DIAG
MENU
STAND BY PLAYER RECORDER INPUT CHECK
SHIFT
F1
DEF
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SERVO
PLAY
REC INHIBIT
REC
Register the edit points of the recorder and player.
ABC
GHI
9
EDIT
REW
AUDIO CH SELECT
CH CH CH
3
A
IN
A
OUT
7
JKL
8
PREVIEW/
REVIEW
PRE-
ROLL
CH
1
CH
5
CH
2
CH
6
CH
3
7
4
8
MNO PQRS
4
5
6
3
T
BS
ENT
F
AUTO
EDIT
TUV WXYZ
TRIM
SET
STOPFF
1
0
2
PUSH
LOCK
IN
OUT
C
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
FULL
FULL
Check and modify, if necessary, the edit points.
4
Adjust the recording
levels.
Preview the material before editing it.
5
Switch the time counter display to TC
or CTL.
Proceed with the editing.
6
When using this VTR as the player
Review the edited results.
7
Press the 9P button for 2 or more seconds
to set the VTR to the REMOTE status which
is indicated when the REMOTE LED is ON).
Set the POWER
switch to ON.
EJECT
XL/L/M-cassette
Do not insert S-cassette
without adapter
POWER OFF
ON
CH1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CUE
REMOTE
CH CONDITION
MONITOR FULL/FINE
R
9P50P
RS-232C
L
HEADPHONES
SHTL
REV
JOG
VAR
ADJUST
PUSH-INTER
HOME
RF1
TC
RF2
CUE
ASSEM
INSERT
VIDEO UNITY
FWD
AUDIO UNITY DIAG
MENU
STAND BY PLAYER RECORDER INPUT CHECK
SHIFT
F1
DEF
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SERVO
PLAY
REC INHIBIT
REC
ABC
GHI
9
EDIT
REW
AUDIO CH SELECT
CH CH CH
A
IN
A
OUT
7
JKL
8
PREVIEW/
REVIEW
PRE-
ROLL
CH
1
CH
5
CH
2
CH
6
CH
3
7
4
8
MNO PQRS
4
5
6
3
T
BS
ENT
F
AUTO
EDIT
TUV WXYZ
TRIM
SET
STOPFF
1
0
2
PUSH
LOCK
IN
OUT
C
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
FULL
FULL
Adjust the playback
levels.
Switch the time counter display to TC
or CTL.
29
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Automatic Editing (deck-to-deck)
Selecting the editing mode
Registering the edit points
Select the editing mode.
ASSEM button:
Assemble (frame-to-frame continuity) editing is
performed in this mode.
INSERT button:
Locate the edit IN point by performing the jog or
shuttle operation. Set the tape to the still picture
status at the desired position.
For a detailed description of the jog and shuttle
operations, refer to page 27.
1
1
Insert editing is performed in this mode.
Press the IN button and SET button together.
The edit IN point is now registered.
The edit IN point value appears on the display.
2
On the time code display, select the channels to be
edited.
2
ASSEM:
Set ASSEM to ON using the
INSERT:
Locate the edit OUT point by performing the jog or
shuttle operation. Set the tape to the still picture
status at the desired position.
3
button.
F1
To select V, A1, A2, A3, A4 and CUE channels,
press the to buttons; to select A5, A6, A7,
Press the OUT button and SET button together.
The edit OUT point is now registered.
The edit OUT point value appears on the display.
4
F1
F6
A8 and TC channels, press the
+
to
F2
SHIFT
+
buttons. The highlighted channels
F6
SHIFT
will now be edited.
The edit points can be registered directly using the
number keys.
1. Select the <ASSEMBLE> or <INSERT> menu.
5
Press the PLAYER or RECORDER button to select
the VTR which is to be operated.
[Setting for editing using two VTRs]
PLAYER:
Press this button if the player VTR is to be
operated to register the edit points.
RECORDER:
3
2. Press the
button to highlight the edit point. Turn
T
the ADJUST dial to move the highlighting to the IN
point or OUT point.
3. Press the
button again, and input the desired edit
T
point directly using the number keys. Turn the
ADJUST dial to move from one digit to the next.
4. Press the
button to register the point.
ENT
Press this button if the recorder VTR (this VTR) is
to be operated to register the edit points.
To abort the registration at any time, press the
button.
C
To reset a particular edit point (to 00:00:00:00), press
the button, align the highlighting with the edit
point concerned, and press the
[ASSEM screen]
T
button again.
T
IN point
OUT point
Next, press the
button and
button together.
F
0
Finally, press the
button to register the point.
ENT
EJECT
XL/L/M-cassette
Do not insert S-cassette
without adapter
POWER OFF
ON
CH1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CUE
REMOTE
CH CONDITION
MONITOR FULL/FINE
R
9P50P
RS-232C
L
HEADPHONES
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SHTL
REV
JOG
VAR
ADJUST
PUSH-INTER
HOME
RF1
TC
RF2
CUE
ASSEM
INSERT
VIDEO UNITY
FWD
AUDIO UNITY DIAG
MENU
STAND BY PLAYER RECORDER INPUT CHECK
SHIFT
F1
DEF
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SERVO
PLAY
REC INHIBIT
REC
ABC
GHI
9
EDIT
REW
AUDIO CH SELECT
CH CH CH
A
IN
A
OUT
7
JKL
8
PREVIEW/
REVIEW
PRE-
ROLL
CH
1
CH
5
CH
2
CH
6
CH
3
7
4
8
MNO PQRS
4
5
6
3
T
BS
ENT
F
[INSERT screen]
AUTO
EDIT
TUV WXYZ
TRIM
SET
STOPFF
1
0
2
PUSH
LOCK
IN
OUT
C
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
FULL
FULL
Marker
IN point
OUT point
2, 4
1, 3
5
Match frame processing function
When two VTRs are used to perform the editing
operations, there will be a total of 4 edit points: the IN
and OUT points for the player and the IN and OUT points
for the recorder. However, the last point is automatically
calculated so only three of the edit points need to be
registered.
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
AUDIO IN point
AUDIO OUT point
Negative duration function
Use setup menu items No.300 (IN/OUT DEL) and
No.301 (NEGA FLASH) in combination.
30
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Automatic Editing (deck-to-deck)
Checking the edit points
Modifying edit points
Press the IN (or OUT) button to check the edit
point.
The value of the registered edit point appears on
the display.
Re-registering an edit point
1
1
Locate the new edit point by performing the jog or
shuttle operation, and press the IN (or OUT) button
and SET button at the same time to re-register the
edit point.
While holding down the IN (or OUT) button, press
the PREROLL button to check the picture at the
edit point.
2
Modifying an edit point in 1-frame increments
(trimming function)
Press the TRIM button while holding down the IN
(or OUT) button.
2
The tape is cued up to the edit IN (or OUT) point,
and a still picture of the point appears.
Each time the i button is pressed, the point is
moved ahead by one frame.
Conversely, each time the j button is pressed, the
point is moved back by one frame.
• If “STOP” has been selected as the setup menu
item No.307 (AFTER CUE-UP) setting, the VTR
is set to the E-E mode provided that EE has
been selected as the <HOME> menu
F1
(OUTPUT) setting.
Resetting edit points
1Resetting both an edit IN point and OUT
3
By holding down the IN and OUT buttons at the
same time, check the editing duration. The
duration appears on the display.
3
point
Press
menu.
(TC CLR = RESET) on the <HOME>
F4
(This takes effect only in the CTL mode.)
How the duration is calculated
• When two edit points have been set
The duration between the two points is
calculated.
2Resetting either an edit IN point or OUT point
Press the
button among the number keys
C
while holding down the IN (or OUT) button.
• When only one edit point has been set
The duration between the data which has been
set and the current address is calculated.
• When no edit points have been set
The duration of the previously edited section is
calculated.
<Notes>
• An edit OUT point can be reset even while
editing is in progress.
• In the eject mode, the IN and OUT points are
automatically reset.
EJECT
3
1
XL/L/M-cassette
Do not insert S-cassette
without adapter
POWER OFF
ON
CH1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CUE
REMOTE
CH CONDITION
MONITOR FULL/FINE
R
EJECT
9P50P
RS-232C
L
XL/L/M-cassette
Do not insert S-cassette
without adapter
HEADPHONES
POWER OFF
ON
SHTL
REV
JOG
VAR
ADJUST
PUSH-INTER
HOME
RF1
TC
RF2
CUE
ASSEM
INSERT
VIDEO UNITY
CH1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CUE
REMOTE
CH CONDITION
MONITOR FULL/FINE
R
FWD
AUDIO UNITY DIAG
MENU
9P50P
RS-232C
L
HEADPHONES
STAND BY PLAYER RECORDER INPUT CHECK
SHTL
REV
JOG
VAR
ADJUST
PUSH-INTER
HOME
RF1
TC
RF2
CUE
ASSEM
INSERT
VIDEO UNITY
SHIFT
F1
DEF
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SERVO
PLAY
REC INHIBIT
REC
ABC
GHI
9
AUDIO UNITY DIAG
MENU
FWD
EDIT
REW
AUDIO CH SELECT
CH CH CH
A
IN
A
OUT
7
JKL
8
PREVIEW/
REVIEW
PRE-
ROLL
CH
1
CH
5
CH
2
CH
6
CH
3
7
4
8
MNO PQRS
STAND BY PLAYER RECORDER INPUT CHECK
4
5
6
3
T
BS
ENT
F
AUTO
EDIT
TUV WXYZ
TRIM
SET
STOPFF
1
0
2
SHIFT
F1
DEF
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
PUSH
LOCK
SERVO
PLAY
REC INHIBIT
REC
IN
OUT
C
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
ABC
GHI
9
EDIT
REW
FULL
FULL
AUDIO CH SELECT
CH CH CH
A
IN
A
OUT
7
JKL
8
PREVIEW/
REVIEW
PRE-
ROLL
CH
1
CH
5
CH
2
CH
6
CH
3
7
4
8
MNO PQRS
4
5
6
3
T
BS
ENT
F
AUTO
EDIT
TUV WXYZ
TRIM
SET
STOPFF
1
0
2
PUSH
LOCK
IN
OUT
C
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
FULL
FULL
2 1, 3
3
2
2
1
31
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Automatic Editing (deck-to-deck)
Previewing
Automatic editing
After the edit points have been registered, press
the PREVIEW button.
Regular preview is now conducted.
Press the AUTO EDIT button.
1
1
Automatic editing is now executed.
• To suspend editing at any time, press the STOP
button.
<Notes>
• When the edit OUT point is reached, the tape is
postrolled, after which it stops.
• If the edit IN point has not been registered, the
position where the PREVIEW button was
pressed is registered as the edit IN point.
• To stop the preview at any time, press the
STOP button.
• When the PREVIEW button is pressed again
after the IN point during the course of a preview,
the preview will start again from the beginning.
• When the edit OUT point is reached, the tape is
postrolled, after which it stops automatically.
Postrolling
In the case of assemble editing, editing continues
for about 2 seconds after the edit OUT point is
passed, and the tape is then returned to the OUT
point, after which it stops.
In the case of insert editing, the PLAY mode is
established after the edit OUT point has been
passed, and the tape is then returned to the OUT
point, after which it stops.
Retry function
EJECT
Even when the STOP button has been pressed to
suspend editing, editing can be repeated from the
beginning simply by pressing the AUTO EDIT
button again.
XL/L/M-cassette
Do not insert S-cassette
without adapter
POWER OFF
ON
CH1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CUE
REMOTE
CH CONDITION
MONITOR FULL/FINE
R
9P50P
RS-232C
L
HEADPHONES
SHTL
REV
JOG
VAR
ADJUST
PUSH-INTER
HOME
RF1
TC
RF2
CUE
ASSEM
INSERT
VIDEO UNITY
FWD
AUDIO UNITY DIAG
MENU
STAND BY PLAYER RECORDER INPUT CHECK
Auto tag function
SHIFT
F1
DEF
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SERVO
PLAY
REC INHIBIT
REC
ABC
GHI
9
EDIT
REW
AUDIO CH SELECT
CH CH CH
A
IN
A
OUT
7
JKL
8
PREVIEW/
REVIEW
PRE-
ROLL
CH
1
CH
5
CH
2
CH
6
CH
3
7
4
8
If, upon completion of editing, when the AUTO
EDIT button is pressed although the next edit point
has not yet been registered, the previous edit OUT
point is registered as the IN point, and editing is
executed.
To release the auto tag mode, press one of the
transport system buttons (such as the PLAY
button).
MNO PQRS
4
5
6
3
T
BS
ENT
F
AUTO
EDIT
TUV WXYZ
TRIM
SET
STOPFF
1
0
2
PUSH
LOCK
IN
OUT
C
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
FULL
FULL
1
<Note>
The registered points are automatically cleared
after editing has been executed. However, the
previous edit points can be recalled by pressing
the TRIMi (or TRIMj) button and SET button at
the same time.
EJECT
XL/L/M-cassette
Do not insert S-cassette
without adapter
POWER OFF
ON
CH1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CUE
REMOTE
CH CONDITION
MONITOR FULL/FINE
R
9P50P
RS-232C
L
HEADPHONES
SHTL
REV
JOG
VAR
ADJUST
PUSH-INTER
HOME
RF1
TC
RF2
CUE
ASSEM
INSERT
VIDEO UNITY
FWD
AUDIO UNITY DIAG
MENU
STAND BY PLAYER RECORDER INPUT CHECK
SHIFT
F1
DEF
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SERVO
PLAY
REC INHIBIT
REC
ABC
GHI
9
EDIT
REW
AUDIO CH SELECT
CH CH CH
A
IN
A
OUT
7
JKL
8
PREVIEW/
REVIEW
PRE-
ROLL
CH
1
CH
5
CH
2
CH
6
CH
3
7
4
8
MNO PQRS
4
5
6
3
T
BS
ENT
F
AUTO
EDIT
TUV WXYZ
TRIM
SET
STOPFF
1
0
2
PUSH
LOCK
IN
OUT
C
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
FULL
FULL
1
32
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Automatic Editing (deck-to-deck)
Reviewing
Upon completion of the editing, press the REVIEW
button.
Review is now started by the recorder.
• To stop the review at any time, press the STOP
button.
1
• When the edit OUT point is reached, the tape is
postrolled, after which it stops.
EJECT
XL/L/M-cassette
Do not insert S-cassette
without adapter
POWER OFF
ON
CH1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CUE
REMOTE
CH CONDITION
MONITOR FULL/FINE
R
9P50P
RS-232C
L
HEADPHONES
SHTL
REV
JOG
VAR
ADJUST
PUSH-INTER
HOME
RF1
TC
RF2
CUE
ASSEM
INSERT
VIDEO UNITY
FWD
AUDIO UNITY DIAG
MENU
STAND BY PLAYER RECORDER INPUT CHECK
SHIFT
F1
DEF
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SERVO
PLAY
REC INHIBIT
REC
ABC
GHI
9
EDIT
REW
AUDIO CH SELECT
CH CH CH
A
IN
A
OUT
7
JKL
8
PREVIEW/
REVIEW
PRE-
ROLL
CH
1
CH
5
CH
2
CH
6
CH
3
7
4
8
MNO PQRS
4
5
6
3
T
BS
ENT
F
AUTO
EDIT
TUV WXYZ
TRIM
SET
STOPFF
1
0
2
PUSH
LOCK
IN
OUT
C
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
FULL
FULL
1
33
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Audio Split Editing
The video edit points and audio edit points can be
registered independently, and editing can be executed
with the video points offset from the audio points.
Audio edit points cannot be registered when the
assemble editing mode has been selected.
EJECT
XL/L/M-cassette
Do not insert S-cassette
without adapter
POWER OFF
ON
CH1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CUE
REMOTE
CH CONDITION
MONITOR FULL/FINE
R
9P50P
RS-232C
L
HEADPHONES
SHTL
REV
JOG
VAR
ADJUST
PUSH-INTER
HOME
RF1
TC
RF2
CUE
ASSEM
INSERT
VIDEO UNITY
FWD
AUDIO UNITY DIAG
MENU
STAND BY PLAYER RECORDER INPUT CHECK
After registering the edit points, proceed with the
same operations as for insert editing.
SHIFT
F1
DEF
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SERVO
PLAY
REC INHIBIT
REC
ABC
GHI
9
EDIT
REW
AUDIO CH SELECT
CH CH CH
A
IN
A
OUT
7
JKL
8
PREVIEW/
REVIEW
PRE-
ROLL
CH
1
CH
5
CH
2
CH
6
CH
3
7
4
8
MNO PQRS
4
5
6
3
T
BS
ENT
F
AUTO
EDIT
TUV WXYZ
TRIM
SET
STOPFF
1
0
2
PUSH
LOCK
IN
OUT
C
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
FULL
FULL
∫Registering the edit points
Video IN point:
While holding down the IN button, press the SET
A-IN button A-OUT button
button.
Video OUT point:
While holding down the OUT button, press the SET
∫Modifying the edit points
Video IN point:
While holding down the IN button, press the TRIMi
button or TRIMj button.
Video OUT point:
While holding down the OUT button, press the
TRIMi button or TRIMj button.
Audio IN point:
While holding down the A-IN button, press the
TRIMi button or TRIMj button.
Audio OUT point:
button.
Audio IN point:
While holding down the A-IN button, press the SET
button.
Audio OUT point:
While holding down the A-OUT button, press the
SET button.
<Note>
If the editing mode is changed to assemble editing
after the audio edit points have been registered, the
audio edit points will be cleared.
While holding down the A-OUT button, press the
TRIMi button or TRIMj button.
∫Cueing the tape up to the edit points
Cue-up to video IN point:
∫Clearing the edit points
Video IN point:
While holding down the IN button, press the
PREROLL button.
Cue-up to video OUT point:
While holding down the OUT button, press the
PREROLL button.
Cue-up to audio IN point:
While holding down the A-IN button, press the
PREROLL button.
Cue-up to audio OUT point:
While holding down the A-OUT button, press the
PREROLL button.
While holding down the IN button, press the
button among the number keys.
Video OUT point:
While holding down the OUT button, press the
button among the number keys.
Audio IN point:
While holding down the A-IN button, press the
button among the number keys.
Audio OUT point:
C
C
C
C
While holding down the A-OUT button, press the
button among the number keys.
34
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Audio Split Editing
∫Duration display
The duration can be indicated on the display.
Between the video IN and OUT points:
Press the IN button and OUT button at the same
time.
Between the audio IN and OUT points:
Press the A-IN button and A-OUT button at the
same time.
Match frame processing function
When two VTRs are used to perform the audio split
editing operations, there will be a total of 8 edit
points: the video IN and OUT points for the player,
the video IN and OUT points for the recorder, the
audio IN and OUT points for the player, and the
audio IN and OUT points for the recorder.
When five of the eight edit points are registered, the
remaining three points are automatically calculated
so only five of the edit points can be registered.
∫When a VTR not equipped with the split
editing function is used as the player
When a VTR for which the video and audio edit
points cannot be set independently is used as the
player, split editing is still possible by setting the
audio IN point and OUT point in the recorder and
setting the data of three points as the video edit
points.
<Note>
If, during audio split editing, the video OUT point (or
audio OUT point) only is registered without the
audio OUT (or video OUT point) having been
registered and automatic editing is then executed,
editing will continue until either the audio OUT point
(or video OUT point) is registered or the STOP
button is pressed to suspend the editing operation.
35
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Variable memory function
Variable memory function selection
Variable memory playback operation procedure
The variable memory mode can be selected by setting
2
(VARMEM) on the <HOME SHIFT> menu to
F6
EJECT
“ON.”
XL/L/M-cassette
Do not insert S-cassette
without adapter
POWER OFF
ON
When
(VARMEM) is set to “OFF,” the variable
F6
CH1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CUE
REMOTE
CH CONDITION
MONITOR FULL/FINE
R
9P50P
RS-232C
L
memory mode is canceled, and the regular mode is
established.
HEADPHONES
SHTL
REV
JOG
VAR
ADJUST
PUSH-INTER
HOME
RF1
TC
RF2
CUE
ASSEM
INSERT
VIDEO UNITY
FWD
AUDIO UNITY DIAG
MENU
STAND BY PLAYER RECORDER INPUT CHECK
<Note>
SHIFT
F1
DEF
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SERVO
PLAY
REC INHIBIT
REC
Bear in mind that when the 23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD or
SD) mode has been selected as the system menu
item No.25 (SYSTEM FREQ) setting,
ABC
GHI
9
EDIT
REW
AUDIO CH SELECT
CH CH CH
A
IN
A
OUT
7
JKL
8
PREVIEW/
REVIEW
PRE-
ROLL
CH
1
CH
5
CH
2
CH
6
CH
3
7
4
8
MNO PQRS
4
5
6
3
T
BS
ENT
F
AUTO
EDIT
TUV WXYZ
TRIM
SET
STOPFF
1
0
2
PUSH
LOCK
IN
OUT
C
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
(VARMEM)
F6
FULL
FULL
will no longer appear on the display and the variable
memory mode cannot be selected.
1
6
5
4
3
Outline
To perform variable memory playback operations, set
the VTR to the variable memory mode, and take the
steps below.
This VTR is provided with two variable memory
functions, as follows. These functions can be used in
the variable memory mode.
Register the IN point using the SET button and IN
button. There is no need to set the OUT point for
variable memory playback.
1
Variable memory playback:
Any section of the tape can be played back at variable
speeds in the VAR mode, the changes in the speed
can be stored in the memory, and the tape can be
played back at the memorized speed.
Set the initial speed (j1.0k to i2.0k) using the
search dial while holding down the SET button.
2
Variable memory editing:
Using the VTR as a controller (recorder in the deck-to-
deck mode) to control the playback speed of the
player, editing can be performed in the variable speed
mode.
When the SET button and PREVIEW/REVIEW
3
button are pressed at the same time, the tape is
automatically prerolled and played back at the
initial speed setting up to the IN point.
After the tape has passed the IN point, turn the
search dial to store the playback speed in the
memory.
4
Press the STOP button to stop the tape.
5
When the PREVIEW/REVIEW button is pressed,
variable memory playback is performed at the
memorized speed.
6
<Notes>
• After passing the IN point, the tape is played back
in accordance with the settings in the memory, and
it continues to run at the last speed stored in the
memory until the STOP button is pressed.
• Whatever is stored in the memory will be cleared
when the VTR exits the variable memory mode. It
is also cleared when the POWER switch is set to
“OFF.”
36
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Variable memory function
Variable memory editing operation procedure
9
4
6
When the AUTO EDIT button is pressed, variable
memory editing is executed. Once editing has
been executed, the memorized speeds will be
cleared except for the initial speed which is not
cleared.
8
9
1
5
EJECT
XL/L/M
Do not insert S-cassette
without adapter
-
cassette
POWER OFF
ON
CH1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CUE
REMOTE
CH CONDITION
MONITOR FULL/FINE
R
9P50P
RS-232C
L
HEADPHONES
SHTL
REV
JOG
VAR
ADJUST
PUSH-INTER
HOME
RF1
TC
RF2
CUE
ASSEM
INSERT
VIDEO UNITY
By pressing the PREVIEW/REVIEW button, the
edited results can be checked.
FWD
AUDIO UNITY DIAG
MENU
STAND BY PLAYER RECORDER INPUT CHECK
SHIFT
F1
DEF
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SERVO
PLAY
REC INHIBIT
REC
ABC
GHI
9
EDIT
REW
AUDIO CH SELECT
CH CH CH
A
IN
A
OUT
7
8
PREVIEW/
REVIEW
PRE-
ROLL
CH
1
CH
5
CH
2
CH
6
CH
3
7
4
8
JKL
MNO PQRS
4
5
6
3
T
BS
ENT
F
AUTO
EDIT
TUV WXYZ
TRIM
SET
STOPFF
1
0
2
PUSH
LOCK
<Notes>
IN
OUT
C
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
FULL
FULL
• Whatever is stored in the memory will be cleared
when the VTR exits the variable memory mode. It
is also cleared when the POWER switch is set to
“OFF.”
• Phase synchronization is not performed during
playback up to the IN point of the variable memory
editing. Therefore, depending on the VTR used as
the player and its speed setting, no guarantees are
made for the accuracy of the IN point.
• When conducting variable memory editing in the
speed range of j1.0k to i2.0k, use VTRs with
which these speeds are guaranteed for both the
recorder and player.
8
3
2
To perform variable memory editing operations, set
this VTR, which is connected as the recorder to the
variable memory mode, and take the steps below.
Select the editing mode on the <ASSEMBLE> or
1
<INSERT> menu.
Select the VTR to be operated by pressing the
RECORDER or PLAYER button.
2
Register the IN and OUT points using the SET
button and IN and OUT buttons. The player’s OUT
point cannot be registered.
3
Press the PLAYER button to select the player
VTR, and then set the initial speed using the
search dial while holding down the SET button.
4
When the SET button and PREVIEW/REVIEW
5
button are pressed at the same time, the tapes in
both the player and recorder are automatically
prerolled, and the player VTR plays back the tape
at the initial speed setting up to the IN point.
After the tape has passed the IN point, turn the
search dial to store the playback speed of the
player VTR in the memory.
6
When the tape passes the OUT point that was set
by the recorder, the storing of the playback speed
in the memory ends.
7
37
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Function menus
The function menus are used to set the functions which are frequently used.
The function menus are selected directly using the direct menu buttons on the front panel.
General description
General menus
Special menus
<HOME>, <HOME SHIFT>
<<SYSTEM MENU>>
The most basic settings for recording, playback and
TC operations are set on these menu screens.
The SYSTEM menu is displayed on-screen, enabling
various adjustments to be made.
<VIDEO>, <VIDEO SHIFT>
<<SETUP MENU>>
The basic input/output settings for the video signals
are performed and, moreover, the level of the HD
output signals can also be adjusted on these menu
screens.
The SETUP menu is displayed on-screen, enabling
various adjustments to be made.
<<FILE>>
The current setting information, including the SETUP
menu contents, can be provided with titles and either
saved in or loaded from the backup memory in one of
4 variations.
<AUDIO>, <AUDIO SHIFT1>, <AUDIO SHIFT2>
The basic input/output settings for the audio signals
are performed on these menu screens.
<TC>, <TC SHIFT>
The TC-related settings are performed on these menu
screens.
The settings for superimposing time codes on the
display can also be performed on these menu
screens.
<<PF1 FT ASSIGN>>, <<PF1 BK ASSIGN>>
<<PF2 FT ASSIGN>>, <<PF2 BK ASSIGN>>
The SETUP menu items which can be registered are
displayed on-screen, and they can be registered into
or deleted from the function buttons.
<<IC CARD MENU>>
<PF1 FT>, <PF1 BK>, <PF2 FT>, <PF2 BK>
Up to 24 frequently used menu items which have
been registered can be used on these menu screens.
The current setting information, including the SETUP
menu contents, can be provided with titles and saved
onto or loaded from the IC card memory in one of 8
variations.
<CUE>, <CUE SHIFT>
A maximum of 60 cue points can be set on these
menu screens. In the PAGE mode, 10 pages with 6
cue points on each page are provided so that the cue
points can be managed on a page-by-page basis.
<<IC CARD/ERR LOG>>
The contents of the error logs can be provided with
titles and saved onto or loaded from the IC card
memory in one of 8 variations.
<DIAG>, <DIAG SHIFT>
<<IC CARD/MULTI CUE>>
The warnings and hour-meter can be checked on
these menu screens. On the SHIFT menu screen,
error log files can be checked, deleted or saved onto
or loaded from IC cards.
The MULTI CUE menu items can be provided with
titles and saved onto or loaded from the IC card
memory in one of 8 variations.
<<50P IN ASSIGN>>, <<50P OUT ASSIGN>>
Using the front panel controls and on-screen menus,
the functions are registered into the input pins of the
parallel remote (50PIN) connector and the statuses
are registered into its output pins.
<MENU>, <MENU SHIFT>
These enable movement to the screens for operations
(adjustments, saving data onto or loading it from the
internal memory or IC cards) relating to the SYSTEM
and SETUP menus.
<ASSEMBLE>
The ASSEMBLE editing mode is selected on this
menu screen.
<INSERT>
The INSERT editing mode and editing channels are
selected on this menu screen.
38
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
GENERAL
DESCRIPTION
Function menus
Allocating the function keys
Items allocated to function keys
Menu (6 types)
Menu hierarchy
F1
F2
F3
TC/CTL
OUTREF
WFM
F4
F5
F6
1st
OUTPUT
PREROL
VID IN
TC CLR
CAPSTN
R INH
HOME
VIDEO
2nd (SHIFT)
1st
VARMEM
DW CON
HUESUP
B-CT
INT SG
UP CON
LV
2nd (SHIFT)
3rd (F+SHIFT)
1st
V
LV
C
LV
BR
A1 IN
A5 IN
(SHIFT)
TC SRC
SUPER
CT
R-BR
B-BR
A3 IN
A7 IN
R-CT
A4 IN
A8 IN
A2 IN
A6 IN
DIN 12
DIN 56
DIN 34
DIN 78
2nd (SHIFT)
3rd
AUDIO
CCUEVOLUMERE
M
MIX
1st
TCG MD
C VPOS
TCG RG
DISPLY
RUN MD
C TYPE
DF MOD
TIMER
TC
2nd (SHIFT)
1st
C HPOS
PF1
2nd (SHIFT)
1st
No factory settings (any items can be allocated to any keys).
PF2
2nd (SHIFT)
1st
PREV
NEXT
MODE
CLR
AL CLR
CUE
MULTICUE function
2nd
(SHIFT)
CARD
PAGEROTATECU-ROL
1st
WARN
STEP
HOURS
CARD
DIAG
ERROR LOG function
2nd (SHIFT)
1st
AL CLR
FILE
CARD
SYSTEM
PF2 BK
SETUP
50P IN
MENU
2nd (SHIFT)
PF1 FT
ASSEM
PF1 BK
PF2 FT
50P OT
ASSEM
INSERT
A5
A1
A6
A2
A7
A3
A8
A4
TC
V
CUE
SYSTEM
SYSTEM MENU (ON SCREEN)
CANCEL
CANCEL
SAVE >
CANCEL
RESET
RESET
SET
SET
EXIT
EXIT
EXIT
EXIT
SETUP
: PREV
P.LOAD
: PREV
; NEXT
LOAD <
; NEXT
SETUP MENU (ON SCREEN)
FILE
LOCK
SET
USER FILE BACKUP function
PF1, PF2
MENU ASSIGN function
RESET
DELETE
RESET
CARD
IC CARD function (MENU)
IC CARD function (ERRLOG)
IC CARD function (MULTI CUE)
EXIT
EXIT
FORMAT
SAVE <
LOAD >
LOCK
SET
50PIN
: PREV
; NEXT
CANCEL
50-pin ASSIGN function
Warning mark
When a warning occurs in this VTR, the warning mark (W) blinks. If the DIAG button is then pressed, the corresponding warning message is
displayed on the screen. ( See DIAG screen.)
39
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Function menus
How to switch the settings
Toggle:
Each time a function button is pressed, the setting is
changed or entered.
F i toggle*:
When a function button is pressed while the F button
is held down, the setting can be changed or entered
each time.
Toggle i ADJ:
When a function button is pressed, the setting is
highlighted, and the status in which the setting can be
changed is established.
The ADJUST dial is used to change the setting.
When the same function button is pressed again and
the highlighting is released, the setting is entered.
Press:
When a function button is pressed, the setting can be
changed while the button is held down or at the
instant when it is pressed. When the function button
is released, the original setting is restored.
F i press*:
When a function button is pressed while the F button
is held down, the setting can be changed while the
button is held down or at the instant when it is
pressed. When the function button is released, the
original setting is restored.
* When only the function button is pressed, message
display “Press
i
” etc. blinks.
F5
F
40
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
HOW TO SWITCH
THE SETTINGS
Function menus
<HOME>
The most basic settings for recording, playback and
TC operations are set on this menu screen.
Status display 1
Warning mark
Status display 2
Name of menu displayed
Remaining tape/total tape
Operation mode/speed
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
System frequency display during 24 Hz, 25 Hz (HD and SD)
modes
When 24 Hz mode or 25 Hz (HD or SD) mode has been selected
for the system menu item No. 25 (SYSTEM FREQ), the selected
system frequency contents are displayed for the F1 function button,
making it possible to check the currently selected system frequency
mode.
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SYSTEM
23/24
23/24
The 23/24 Hz mode is selected.
The 25 (HD) Hz mode is selected.
The 25 (SD) Hz mode is selected.
Time counter
Cue time
Back menu indicator
25 (HD)
25 (SD)
F1
Variable memory mode indicator
Status display 1
VTR
Description of settings
PB FMT
Playback format
This displays the format used
for playback.
1080i LP
720p LP
1080i SP
720p SP
422
These settings indicate the DVCPRO HD-LP recording and playback
mode.
These settings indicate the DVCPRO HD-SP playback mode.
These settings indicate the DVCPRO (50 Mbps format) playback mode.
420p
411
These settings indicate the DVCPRO (25 Mbps format), DV and DVCAM
playback modes.
DV
DVCAM
1080i
1
REC FMT*
Recording format
This displays the format used
for recording.
The tape is recorded using the 1080i format.
The tape is recorded using the 720p format.
A cassette tape has not been inserted.
720p
- - -
2
TM INFO*
Tape management
information
This displays the frame rate
(shooting speed) information
which is recorded on a tape
shot by a variable frame rate
camera.
24P
24PA
25P
These settings indicate the recorded frame rate.
INVALID
The tape management information is invalid.
<Note>
In some cases, the tape management information may be erroneously
overwritten by insert editing or tape dubbing, and it may not be possible to
perform editing properly.
*1: This status is not displayed when the 23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD or SD) mode has been selected as the system menu item
No.25 (SYSTEM FREQ) setting.
*2: This status is not displayed when the 59/60 Hz or 50 Hz mode has been selected as the system menu item No.25
(SYSTEM FREQ) setting.
41
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Function menus
Status display 1 (continued)
VTR
Description of settings
REF
Output reference
This displays the output
reference status.
HD23
HD24
HD25
HD50
HD59
HD60
IN50
The HD REF input signal has been selected as the reference. The frame
frequency is 23.98 Hz.
The HD REF input signal has been selected as the reference. The frame
frequency is 24 Hz.
The HD REF input signal has been selected as the reference. The frame
frequency is 25 Hz.
The HD REF input signal has been selected as the reference. The field
frequency is 50 Hz.
The HD REF input signal has been selected as the reference. The field
frequency is 59.94 Hz.
The HD REF input signal has been selected as the reference. The field
frequency is 60 Hz.
The HD serial input signal has been selected as the reference. The field
frequency is 50 Hz.
IN59
The HD serial input signal has been selected as the reference. The field
frequency is 59.94 Hz.
IN60
The HD serial input signal has been selected as the reference. The field
frequency is 60 Hz.
INT23
INT24
INT25
INT50
INT59
INT60
NTSC59
The signal (23.98 Hz) from the internal generator has been selected as the reference.
The signal (24 Hz) from the internal generator has been selected as the reference.
The signal (25 Hz) from the internal generator has been selected as the reference.
The signal (50 Hz) from the internal generator has been selected as the reference.
The signal (59.94 Hz) from the internal generator has been selected as the reference.
The signal (60 Hz) from the internal generator has been selected as the reference.
The SD REF input signal has been selected as the reference. The field
frequency is 59.94 Hz.
PAL50
The SD REF input signal has been selected as the reference. The field
frequency is 50 Hz.
INT59N
The SD REF signal has been selected by the OUT REF setting. Since the
SD REF signal is not input, the signal (59.94 Hz) from the internal
generator is selected as the reference.
INT50P
The SD REF input signal has been selected by the OUT REF setting.
Since the SD REF signal is not input, the signal (50 Hz) from the internal
generator is selected as the reference.
42
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
HOME
Function menus
<HOME>
Playback reference signal (OutRef) specifications for tape playback
59.94 Hz/60 Hz, 50 Hz mode
OUTREF setting (menu 031)
Input signal provided (“Yes”)/not provided (“No”)
HD_REF_IN SD_REF_IN
INPUT
Yes
No
AUTO
EXT_HD_REF
HD_REF_IN
HD_REF_IN
HD_REF_IN
HD_REF_IN
Internal HD
Internal HD
Internal HD
Internal HD
EXT_SD_REF
SD_REF_IN
SD_REF_IN
Internal SD
Internal SD
SD_REF_IN
SD_REF_IN
Internal SD
Internal SD
INPUT
INPUT
HD_REF_IN
HD_REF_IN
HD_REF_IN
HD_REF_IN
SD_REF_IN
SD_REF_IN
INPUT
Yes
Internal HD
INPUT
Yes
Yes
No
No
Internal HD
INPUT
Yes
No
Yes
Internal HD
INPUT
No
Yes
No
No
Internal HD
Internal HD
23.98/24Hz, 25 Hz (HD) mode
25 Hz (SD) mode
Input signal provided
(“Yes”)/not provided (“No”)
Input signal provided (“Yes”)/
not provided (“No”)
OUT REF setting (Menu 031)
HD_REF_IN
HD_REF_IN
SD_REF_IN
AUTO
HD_REF
SD_REF
Yes
No
HD_REF_IN HD_REF_IN SD_REF_IN
HD_REF_IN HD_REF_IN Internal SD
SD_REF_IN Internal HD SD_REF_IN
Yes
No
HD_REF_IN
Internal HD
Yes
Yes
No
No
Internal HD
Internal HD
Internal SD
Internal HD: HD playback reference, 74MHzCLK operates at FreeRun setting.
Internal SD: SD playback reference, 4fscCLK operates at FreeRun setting.
59.94 Hz/60 Hz operation specifications for tape playback
OUTREF setting (menu 031)
Input signal provided (“Yes”)/not provided (“No”)
HD_REF_IN SD_REF_IN
INPUT
AUTO
EXT_HD_REF
EXT_SD_REF
INPUT
Complies with HD
REF IN frequency.
Complies with HD
REF IN frequency.
Complies with INPUT
frequency.
Yes
59.94Hz
Yes
Complies with HD
REF IN frequency.
Complies with HD
REF IN frequency.
Complies with Menu
030 setting.
No
Yes
No
59.94Hz
59.94Hz
59.94Hz
59.94Hz
59.94Hz
59.94Hz
59.94Hz
Yes
Complies with HD
REF IN frequency.
Complies with HD
REF IN frequency.
Complies with INPUT
frequency.
No
Complies with HD
REF IN frequency.
Complies with HD
REF IN frequency.
Complies with Menu
030 setting.
Complies with Menu
030 setting.
Complies with INPUT
frequency.
Yes
No
59.94Hz
59.94Hz
Yes
Complies with Menu
030 setting.
Complies with Menu
030 setting.
No
Complies with INPUT Complies with Menu
Complies with INPUT
frequency.
Yes
No
frequency.
030 setting.
No
Complies with Menu
030 setting.
Complies with Menu
030 setting.
Complies with Menu
030 setting.
Menu 030: HD FREQUENCY 59.94/60 selection
<Note>
Operation cannot be performed in the 60 Hz mode during SD tape playback.
43
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Function menus
<HOME>
Status display 2
Remaining tape/total tape display
The lengths of the remaining tape and total tape of the
inserted cassette are displayed in increments of minutes.
Indicator
SCH
Description of setting
This lights when the SCH phase of the SDREF
signal is within the prescribed range.
Example:
(10 minutes remaining on a 92-minute tape)
Total tape
REM 10/ 92
CF
DF
This lights when color framing is locked.
Remaining tape
This lights during recording or playback in the
drop frame mode.
<Note>
<Note>
Slight errors may occur. The remaining tape value
blinks when less than 3 minutes of the tape remain.
If the time code data could not be read properly
(“T¢R” is displayed), the display of the previous
status is held.
Cue time display
This displays the currently registered cue time. (For
details on the cue time operation, refer to “Cue point
registration, preroll and cue-up.”)
Cue time operations can be performed on the HOME
screen only.
Operation mode (speed) display
This indicates the current operation mode (including
the speed display).
Display
EJECT
Operation mode
Eject mode
Time counter displays
STANDBY OFF
T.RELEASE
STOP
Standby OFF mode
Tension release mode
Stop mode
Display
Description
CTL counter data
CTL
TCG
UBG
tcg
PREROLL
PLAY
Preroll mode
Time code data of time code generator
User’s bit data of time code generator
Playback mode
Special playback (playback phase
adjustment) mode (FWD direction)
PLAY i
When the time code data of time code
generator is preset
Special playback (playback phase
adjustment) mode (REV direction)
ubg
When the user’s bit data of time code
generator is preset
PLAY j
Time code data of time code reader
User’s bit data of time code reader
TCR/T¢R
REC
Recording mode
Jog mode
UBR/U¢R
JOG
REV/STILL/FWD
If the time code data or user’s bit data could not be
¢
¢
read out properly, “T R” or “U R” is displayed. If the
CTL signal is present, the time code data is
supplemented by CTL.
VAR (speed)
[j4.9 to i4.9]
Variable mode
Shuttle mode
SHTL (speed)
[j32.0 to i32.0]
FF
Fast forwarding mode
Rewinding mode
Editing mode
Field mark
TCR 00:00:00:00.
[1st field: “ ”/2nd field: “.”]
(This does not appear when the i0.3k or
j0.3k speed is exceeded.)
REW
EDIT
AUTO EDIT
PREVIEW
REVIEW
Automatic editing mode
Preview mode
Drop frame mark (59/60 Hz mode only)
[Non-drop frame mode: “:”/drop frame
mode: “.”]
Review mode
When function F6 (VARMEM) on <HOME SHIFT> is “ON”
DSPD (speed)
[j1.0 to i2.0]
Initial speed setting of variable memory
Variable memory mode indicator
F6
This is displayed when the
(VARMEM) function
DSMP(speed)
[j1.0 to i2.0]
Playback speed memory mode of variable
memory
button on <HOME SHIFT> is set to “ON.” While
is lighted, variable memory operations can be
performed at any time.
VM
DPLY (speed)
[j1.0 to i2.0]
Playback mode of variable memory
(For details, refer to “Variable memory function.”)
DPRV (speed)
[j1.0 to i2.0]
Preview mode of variable memory editing
Execution mode of variable memory editing
DEDT (speed)
[j1.0 to i2.0]
44
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
HOME
Function menus
<HOME>
Registering TCG values
1. Selecting the values
3. Entering the input values
Press the button. The value input is
Press the
Press the
TC/CTL button to select TC.
F3
ENT
button. The selected item (cue time
T
registered, and the normal display is restored.
or TC) is now highlighted.
<Notes>
• To cancel the registration, press the
button.
C
Turn the ADJUST dial to select TC.
Again press the
highlighted, and the mode for inputting numerical
values is established.
button. A single digit is
T
• If the input value is outside the registration
enable range, the alarm blinks, and
INVALID
the value cannot be registered until it has been
corrected.
<Notes>
• The UBG value and cue time can be registered
in the same way. The CTL value cannot be
registered.
• TC or UB can be registered only when the
internal time code generator has been selected.
2. Inputting numbers and letters
Press the
to
number keys to input
0
9
numerical values.
Use the buttons to input A, B and C, and
+
F
7
the
+
buttons to input D, E and F.
F
8
To move the input digit, turn the ADJUST dial.
To input a minus sign, press the and
]
]
F
TRIMj
buttons when the left-most digit is highlighted.
To input a plus sign, press the and
F
TRIMi
buttons when the left-most digit is highlighted or
press the button.
0
(The display goes blank.)
To clear all the digits to zero, press the
buttons.
and
F
0
<Notes>
• When the
button is tapped while the
7
F
button is held down, the display changes in the
following sequence: A > B > C > A > B and
so on. The same applies when D, E and F are
input using
and
.
F
8
• If, when “REV” has been selected as the setup
menu item No.144 (TC INPUT) setting, the
F
button is released while a letter is being input,
the displayed character will be entered.
• Letters can be input only while a UBG value is
being registered.
• The input of a minus number is possible only
while the cue time is being registered after
“d12h” is selected as the setup menu No.002
(TAPE TIMER) setting and CTL is selected by
the
TC/CTL button.
F3
• If “REV” has been selected as the setup menu
item No.144 (TC INPUT) setting, the input
starts from the highest order digit (the display
appears from the far right). However, turning
the ADJUST dial once will restore the NORMAL
input mode.
45
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Function menus
<HOME>
Function
button/item
Switching
method
Corresponding setup
menu item
Setting
TAPE
Description of setting
For selecting the output signals.
F1
Toggle
No. 140
OUTPUT
EE
OUTPUT
<In the STOP mode>
TAPE: In the STOP mode, the signals played back from the
tape are output.
During recording or editing (*), simultaneous playback
signals are output.
*: Setup menu item No.302 (CONFI EDIT) must be set.
EE: The input signals selected by the setup menu items
No.600 (VIDEO IN SEL) and No.713 (CH1 IN SEL) to
No.724 (D IN SEL 78) settings are output.
F2
___
___
___
___
___
___
F3
TC/CTL*
Toggle
TC
UB
For selecting the time counter display.
2
CTL
TC: The time code value is displayed.
UB: The user’s bit value is displayed.
CTL: The control signal (time data) is displayed.
F4
TC CLR*
Press
RESET
For resetting the time counter display.
If the F4 button is pressed while the control signal (time
data) is displayed on the time counter, it is reset to zero.
___
___
1
F5
___
___
___
___
F6
OFF
No. 113
Refer to the setup menu.
F i toggle
R INH
ALL
REC INH
<Note>
PRE
NORM
V/CTL
The setting can be changed from OFF to ALL simply by
operating the function button without pressing the F button.
F1 (SHIFT)
PREROL
0s --- 5s ---
30s
No. 000
P-ROLL TIME
Refer to the setup menu.
___
Toggle i
ADJ
F2 (SHIFT)
___
___
___
___
F3 (SHIFT)
OUTREF
AUTO
INPUT
No. 031
OUT REF
Refer to the setup menu.
F i toggle
HD_REF
SD_REF
F4 (SHIFT)
CAPSTN
2F
4F
8F
No. 109
CAP. LOCK
Refer to the setup menu.
F i toggle
F5 (SHIFT)
___
___
___
___
___
___
F6 (SHIFT)
Toggle
OFF
ON
For selecting the variable memory mode.
1
VARMEM*
OFF:The variable memory mode is not used.
ON: The status is established in which variable memory
playback or variable memory editing is enabled.
*1: This item is not displayed when the 23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD or SD) mode has been selected as the system menu item No.25 (SYSTEM
FREQ) setting.
*2: CTL cannot be selected when the 23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD or SD) mode has been selected as the system menu item No.25 (SYSTEM
FREQ) setting. TC is selected when the power is turned on.
*The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
46
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
VIDEO
Function menus
<VIDEO>
The basic input/output settings for the video signals
are set, and the level of the HD output signals can
also be adjusted on these menu screens.
1. Video signal input switching, internal signal
source type changing, and up-converter aspect
ratio conversion
2. Video signal output level adjustments
Time counter
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
3. LCD monitor brightness and color adjustments
F
SHIFT
This display appears when the
+
buttons are
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
pressed. Refer to setup menu items No.670 to 675.
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
Function
button/item
Switching
method
Corresponding setup
menu item
Setting
Description of setting
Refer to the setup menu.
F1
Toggle
INT SG
No. 600
VID IN
HDSDI
SDTI
VIDEO IN SEL
The SD SDI and SDTI settings will not appear if the optional
boards have not been installed.
SDSDI
F2
INT SG
Toggle
100%CB
75%CB
SMPTE
ARIB
No. 601
VIDEO INT SG
Refer to the setup menu.
MB
RAMP
BLACK
PLL
EQ
F3
Toggle
CTL
No. 00
Refer to the setup menu.
WFM
TC
WFM SEL
VIDEO
RF L
RF R
ENV L
ENV R
F4
___
___
___
___
___
F5
UP CON
Toggle
FIT_V
FIT_H
FIT_HV
No. 621
UPCONV MODE
Refer to the setup menu.
F6
DW CON
Toggle
FIT_V
FIT_H
FIT_HV
14:9
No. 620
DOWNCON MODE
Refer to the setup menu.
13:9
*The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
47
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Function menus
<VIDEO>
Function
button/item
Switching
method
Corresponding setup
menu item
Setting
Description of setting
When “CMPST” is selected as the setup menu item No.650 (STYLE) setting
F1 (SHIFT)
___
___
___
___
___
___
F2 (SHIFT)
___
___
___
___
F3 (SHIFT)
V LV
0.0% ---
100.0% ---
200.0%
No. 662
V LEVEL
Refer to the setup menu.
To return to the UNITY (100.0%) level, use F i Press.
Toggle i
ADJ
F4 (SHIFT)
C LV
0.0% ---
100.0% ---
141.3%
No. 663
C LEVEL
Refer to the setup menu.
To return to the UNITY (100.0%) level, use F i Press.
Toggle i
ADJ
F5 (SHIFT)
HUE
No. 664
HUE
Refer to the setup menu.
To return to the UNITY (0.0) level, use F i Press.
Toggle i
ADJ
j31.0 ---
0.0 ---
i31.0
F6 (SHIFT)
SUP LV
No. 665
SETUP LVL
Refer to the setup menu.
To return to the UNITY (0.0%) level, use F i Press.
Toggle i
ADJ
j10.0% ---
0.0% ---
i10.0%
When “CMPNT” is selected as the setup menu item No.650 (STYLE) setting
F1 (SHIFT)
___
___
___
___
___
___
F2 (SHIFT)
___
___
___
___
F3 (SHIFT)
Y HD
0.0% ---
100.0% ---
141.3%
No. 653
Y LVL(HD)
Refer to the setup menu.
To return to the UNITY (100.0%) level, use F i Press.
Toggle i
ADJ
F4 (SHIFT)
Pb HD
0.0% ---
100.0% ---
141.3%
No. 654
Pb LVL(HD)
Refer to the setup menu.
To return to the UNITY (100.0%) level, use F i Press.
Toggle i
ADJ
F5 (SHIFT)
Pr HD
0.0% ---
100.0% ---
141.3%
No. 655
Pr LVL(HD)
Refer to the setup menu.
To return to the UNITY (100.0%) level, use F i Press.
Toggle i
ADJ
F6 (SHIFT)
BK HD
No. 656
BK LVL(HD)
Refer to the setup menu.
To return to the UNITY (0.0%) level, use F i Press.
Toggle i
ADJ
j10.0% ---
0.0% ---
i10.0%
*The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
48
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
AUDIO
Function menus
<AUDIO>
The basic input/output settings for the audio signals
are set on these menu screens.
1. Audio signal input selection (CH1jCH4)
3. Audio volume control switching, CUE audio
recording signal selection, and audio monitor
mix switching
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
2. Audio signal input selection (CH5-CH8)
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
Function
button/item
Corresponding setup
menu item
Setting
Setting
Description of setting
F1
A1 IN
Toggle
Toggle
INT SG
DIGI
ANA
No. 713
CH1 IN SEL
Refer to the setup menu.
Refer to the setup menu.
F2
A2 IN
INT SG
DIGI
No. 714
CH2 IN SEL
ANA
F3
DIN 12
Toggle
Toggle
AES
SDI
No. 721
D IN SEL 12
Refer to the setup menu.
Refer to the setup menu.
F4
A3 IN
INT SG
DIGI
No. 715
CH3 IN SEL
ANA
F5
A4 IN
Toggle
INT SG
DIGI
No. 716
CH4 IN SEL
Refer to the setup menu.
ANA
F6
DIN 34
Toggle
Toggle
AES
SDI
No. 722
D IN SEL 34
Refer to the setup menu.
Refer to the setup menu.
F1 (SHIFT1)
A5 IN
INT SG
DIGI
No. 717
CH5 IN SEL
ANA1
F2 (SHIFT1)
A6 IN
Toggle
INT SG
DIGI
No. 718
CH6 IN SEL
Refer to the setup menu.
ANA2
F3 (SHIFT1)
DIN 56
Toggle
Toggle
AES
SDI
No. 723
D IN SEL 56
Refer to the setup menu.
Refer to the setup menu.
F4 (SHIFT1)
A7 IN
INT SG
DIGI
No. 719
CH7 IN SEL
ANA3
F5 (SHIFT1)
A8 IN
Toggle
Toggle
INT SG
DIGI
ANA4
No. 720
CH8 IN SEL
Refer to the setup menu.
Refer to the setup menu.
F6 (SHIFT1)
DIN 78
AES
SDI
No. 724
D IN SEL 78
*The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
49
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Function menus
<AUDIO>
Function
button/item
Switching
method
Corresponding setup
menu item
Setting
REC
Description of setting
Refer to the setup menu.
F1 (SHIFT2)
VOLUME
Toggle
No. 141
VOLUME
PB
For switching what is to be controlled by the audio volume
controls. (The levels of all the CH1jCH8 channels are controlled.)
AUTO
F2 (SHIFT2)
___
___
___
___
___
F3 (SHIFT2)
RECCUE
Toggle
CUE
CH1
CH2
CH3
CH4
CH5
CH6
CH7
CH8
No. 733
REC CUE
Refer to the setup menu.
i
CH1
CH3
CH5
CH7
CH1
2
4
6
8
8
i
i
i
j
F4 (SHIFT2)
___
___
___
Toggle
___
___
___
___
___
___
F5 (SHIFT2)
___
F6 (SHIFT2)
M MIX
OFF
No. 737
MONI MIX
Refer to the setup menu.
L
R
L/R
*The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
50
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
TC
Function menus
<TC>
The TC-related settings are performed on these menu
screens.Whether the TC is to be superimposed onto
the display can also be set on this screen.
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
Function
button/item
Switching
method
Corresponding setup
menu item
Setting
Description of setting
F1
Toggle
When HD SDI, INT SG or SDTI is selected:
No. 507
Refer to the setup menu.
TC SRC
INT
TC SOURCE
EXT_L
SLTC
SVITC
When SD SDI is selected:
INT
EXT_L
VITC
F2
___
___
___
___
___
F3
TCG MD
Toggle
REGEN
PRE
No. 503
TCG MODE
Refer to the setup menu.
AUTO
F4
TCG RG
Toggle
TC&UB
TC
No. 505
TCG REGEN
Refer to the setup menu.
UB
F5
RUN MD
Toggle
F i toggle
Toggle
REC
FREE
No. 504
RUN MODE
Refer to the setup menu.
Refer to the setup menu.
Refer to the setup menu.
Refer to the setup menu.
Refer to the setup menu.
Refer to the setup menu.
F6
DF MOD
DF
NDF
No. 511
DF MODE
F1 (SHIFT)
SUPER
OFF
ON
No. 005
SUPER
F2 (SHIFT)
C HPOS
0 --- 6 --- 37
No. 007
CHARA H-POS
Toggle i
ADJ
F3 (SHIFT)
C VPOS
0 --- 23 --- 32
No. 008
CHARA V-POS
Toggle i
ADJ
F4 (SHIFT)
DISPLY
Toggle
TIME
No. 006
DISPLAY SEL
T&STA
T&S&M
T&RT
T&YMD
T&MDY
T&DMY
F5 (SHIFT)
C TYPE
Toggle
Toggle
WHITE
W/OUT
No. 009
CHARA TYPE
Refer to the setup menu.
Refer to the setup menu.
F6 (SHIFT)
TIMER
d
12h
No. 002
TAPE TIMER
24h
*The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
51
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Function menus
<CUE>
A maximum of 60 cue points can be set on these menu
Moving to registered points
screens. When “AUTO” has been selected as the
F3
The highlighting on the registered point display area is
moved by turning the ADJUST dial. It is moved in the
ascending order of points when the dial is turned
clockwise and in the descending order of points when
it is turned counterclockwise. When “AUTO” has
(PAGE) setting on the AUTO PAGE mode <CUE SHIFT>
menu, up to 10 pages of cue points with 6 cue points on
each page can be managed on a page-by-page basis.
The 60 cue points are indicated using the page number
display and registered point display areas.
<Note>
Cue points cannot be registered, prerolled, etc. if a
setting other than “ENA” has been selected as the setup
menu item No.001 (LOCAL ENA) setting in the REMOTE
mode.
been selected as the
(PAGE) setting on the
F3
<CUE SHIFT> menu, the highlighting can be moved
also to the previous or next page.
• Depending on the setting selected for
F4
(ROTATE) on the <CUE SHIFT> menu, the
following applies to moving the highlighting in the
ascending order of points.
Page number display area
Cue point data display areas
When “OFF” is set:
Registered point display area
The highlighting cannot be moved from page 9 to
page 0.
When “ON” is set:
The highlighting can be moved from page 9 to page 0.
In moving in the descending order of points, the
highlighting cannot be moved from page 0 to page 9.
•
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
Search point and registered point
operations
Each time the
(MODE) button of the <CUE>
F3
menu is pressed, the search mode and cue point
registration mode are switched alternately. Perform
the search point or registered point operations in the
respective mode.
• When the power is turned on, the search point or
registered point, whichever was established when
the power was last turned off, is established.
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
Page number display area
The page number from 0 to 9 is indicated here.
Registered point display area
On each page, six cue point data managed by
registered point numbers are displayed. A point
whose registered point number is highlighted is
targeted for registration and search.
• When the setting for
(PAGE) or
(ROTATE)
F4
F3
on the <CUE SHIFT> menu has been changed,
“01” (page 0/point no.1) is set for both the search
and registered points.
Shown below is the correlation between the page
numbers and registered point numbers.
Cue point registration mode
It is possible to register points to which the tape is to
Page no. Registered points Page no. Registered points
0
1
2
3
4
01–06
11–16
21–26
31–36
41–46
5
6
7
8
9
51–56
61–66
71–76
81–86
91–96
be prerolled. When the display page has been
changed using the
(PREV) or
(NEXT) button
F2
F1
on the <CUE> menu, the following applies depending
on the setting for
(PAGE) on the <CUE SHIFT>
F3
menu.
When “MANU” is set:
Both the search and registered points move to the top
of the changed page.
When “AUTO” is set:
Only the registered point moves to the top of the
changed page; the search point does not move.
Page operations
Pages can be scrolled in the forward or reverse direction
F1
F2
using the [F1] (PREV) or [F2] (NEXT) function buttons.
F4
•
Depending on the setting selected for [F4] (ROTATE)
on the <CUE SHIFT> menu, the following applies to
scrolling pages in the forward direction.
When “OFF” is set:
Page 0 cannot be scrolled forward from page 9.
When “ON” is set:
Page 0 can be scrolled forward from page 9.
In scrolling pages in the reverse direction, page 9
cannot be scrolled in reverse from page 0.
•
52
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
CUE
Function menus
<CUE>
Search mode
When “AUTO” is set:
The desired search point can be selected, and the
tape can be prerolled to that point.
When the display page has been changed using the
When a page become full during the cue point
registration process, operation automatically moves to
the next page, and registration continues. When
CUE96 on the last page is reached, registration is
[
(PREV) or
(NEXT) button on the <CUE>
F2
F1
2
menu, the following applies depending on the setting
for (PAGE) on the <CUE SHIFT> menu.
automatically terminated. (* )
F3
A change must be made to the points to be registered
if more cue points are to be registered. Check that
the cue point registration mode is established, change
the page, and change the points to be registered. In
this case, the search point will not be changed.
When “MANU” is set:
Both the search and registered points move to the top
of the changed page.
When “AUTO” is set:
Only the search point moves to the top of the changed
page; the registered point does not move.
(*2)If “ON” is selected as the
(ROTATE) setting
F4
on the <CUE SHIFT> menu, the registration of the
cue points will rotate from page 9 (CUE96) to
page 0 (CUE01).
Cue point registration
Turn the ADJUST dial to highlight the point which is to
be registered. When the
button is pressed, the
SET
When registering cue points by number
1. Turn the ADJUST dial to highlight the desired
registered point display area.
current tape position is registered as the cue point.
The following applies depending on the setting for
(PAGE) on the <CUE SHIFT> menu.
When “MANU” is set:
F3
2. Press the
button twice. Only the “10’s” hour
T
Operations are performed on the selected page.
Press the button to register the points in
succession (CUE¢1 > CUE¢2 > ... > CUE¢6) on
the selected page. (Any points already registered will
be overwritten.)
SET
digit of the selected cue point is now highlighted,
and the change enable status is established.
<Note>
When “REV” has been selected as the setup menu
item No.144 (TC INPUT) setting, the input of the
number will start from the higher-order digit (it will
be displayed starting from the far right).
The registration is automatically terminated when
1
CUE¢6 is registered on the page. (* )
A change must be made to the points to be registered
if more cue points are to be registered. Check that
the cue point registration mode is established, change
the page, and change the points to be registered. In
this case, the search point will also move
automatically to the top (CUE¢1) of the changed
page.
3. Input the number using the number keys.
Movement from one digit to the next is done
automatically after one number has been input.
The desired digit can also be selected by turning
the ADJUST dial.
(*1)If “ON” is selected as the
] (ROTATE) setting
4. To enter the number, press the
button.
ENT
F4
on the <CUE SHIFT> menu, the registration of the
cue points will rotate on the same page in the
following order: CUE¢1 > CUE¢2 > ... >
CUE¢6 > CUE¢1 > CUE¢2 > ...
When the display screen is switched or when the
button is pressed during the input process, the
change enable status is released, and the setting is
canceled.
C
53
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Function menus
<CUE>
Clearing registered points
Clearing individual registered points
$
Clearing all the registered points together
$
When
(AL CLR) on the <CUE> menu is pressed
When the
(CLR) button on the <CUE> menu is
F4
F5
while the
button is held down, all the cue point data
F
pressed, the currently selected cue point data is
cleared.
* The point is cleared only when “ENTRY” (cue point
registration mode) is selected as the setting for F3 ]
(MODE) on the <CUE> menu.
currently selected is cleared. The range of the points
which are cleared is as follows depending on the
setting for
(PAGE) on the <CUE SHIFT> menu.
F3
When “MANU” is set:
All the points on the currently selected page are
cleared.
When “AUTO” is set:
Search operations
Turn the ADJUST dial to highlight the desired
registered point.
All the points on all the pages are cleared.
When the PREROLL button is pressed, the preroll
operation is initiated. The tape will not be prerolled if
no cue points have been registered.
Since the tape is not prerolled even if the PREROLL
button is pressed when the cue point registration
mode is established, be absolutely sure to check that
the search mode is established.
After clearing, the search and registered points
appear as follows depending on the setting for
(PAGE) on the <CUE SHIFT> menu.
When “MANU” is set:
F3
A return is made to the top (CUE¢1) of the page
concerned.
When “AUTO” is set:
(The time selected by the <CUE SHIFT> menu [
F5
(CU-ROL) setting, which is different from the normal
preroll time, takes effect as the preroll time in this
mode.)
A return is made automatically to the top (CUE01) of
the first page.
* Points are cleared whether “ENTRY” (cue point
registration mode) or “SEARCH” (search mode) is selected
as the setting for [ F3 ] (MODE) on the <CUE> menu.
Function
button/item
Switching
method
Corresponding setup
Setting
Description of setting
menu item
F1
PREV
Press
Press
For multi-cue page forward scrolling.
___
___
F2
NEXT
For multi-cue page reverse scrolling.
___
___
___
___
___
F3
MODE
Toggle
Press
SEARCH
ENTRY
For selecting the search or cue point registration mode.
F4
CLR
For clearing the currently selected cue data.
ENTRY must be selected as the F3 (MODE) setting.
___
F5
AL CLR
When MANU is selected by SHIFT + F3 (PAGE): All the cue
data on the currently displayed page is cleared.
When AUTO is selected by SHIFT + F3 (PAGE): All the cue
data on all the pages is cleared.
FiPress
___
F6
___
___
FiPress
Toggle
___
___
___
___
___
For calling the MULTI CUE file operation menu.
Refer to the setup menu.
Refer to the setup menu.
Refer to the setup menu.
___
F2 (SHIFT)
CARD
F3 (SHIFT)
PAGE
MANU
AUTO
No. 131
PAGE MODE
F4 (SHIFT)
ROTATE
Toggle
OFF
ON
No. 132
ROTA MODE
F5 (SHIFT)
CU-ROL
0s --- 5s ---
15s
No. 011
CU-ROLL TIME
Toggle i
ADJ
F6 (SHIFT)
___
___
___
___
* This item is not displayed when the 23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD or
SD) mode has been selected as the system menu item No.25
(SYSTEM FREQ) setting.
*The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
54
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
DIAG
Function menus
<DIAG>
The warnings and hour-meter can be checked on
these menu screens. On the SHIFT menu screen,
error log files can be checked, deleted or saved onto
or loaded from IC cards.
Warning messages
which are saved
Description
(Refer to page 118 and following.)
NO RF
A blank section on the tape lasting more
second has been detected.
(During normal playback)
than
1
Warning mark
SV NOT LOCKED
LOW RF
The servo has been disengaged for more
than 3 seconds.
(During recording,
normal playback or editing)
An envelope level which is about 1/3 of
normal or a CTL level which is about 1/6
of normal has been detected for more
than 1 second. (During recording, normal
playback or editing)
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
HIGH ERROR RATE The error rate has deteriorated, and
correction or compensation has been
applied to the video or audio playback
signals. (During normal playback)
LCD monitor displays
Warning display
When a warning occurs in this VTR, the warning mark
(W) blinks at the top left of the screen. If (WARN)
Operation mode display
F1
is now pressed, the details of the warning can be
checked out on the LCD monitor.
Saved warning status display
When more than one warning has occurred, turn the
ADJ dial to scroll through the messages.
Time code display
Hour-meter display
When
(HOURS) is pressed, the hour-meter
F2
information can be checked out on the LCD monitor.
Warning display
Error log function
Operation mode display
This indicates the operation mode at the point when
the warning was saved.
The error log mode can be selected by pressing the
button and switching the screen to <DIAG
SHIFT
SHIFT>.
Warning display
This indicates the warning message which is saved.
Saved warning status display
This indicates the number of the currently displayed
warning which has been saved and the total number
of warnings which have been saved.
Time code display
This indicates the time code at the point when the
warning was saved.
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
General description
When the following warnings have occurred while the
tape is running, the warning messages, time codes
and operating modes are saved, and a list of this
information can be read out on the LCD monitor. Up
to 99 warnings which have occurred can be saved. If
the storage capacity of 99 warnings is exceeded, the
processing that is conducted as a result is based on
the setup menu item No.015 (AUTO STEP) setting.
Cueing up the tape to the warning point
The warning list displayed on the LCD monitor can be
scrolled by turning the ADJ dial. When the warning
occurrence point to be checked is selected and the
PREROLL button is pressed, the tape is cued up to
the position of the time code which has been saved.
55
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Function menus
<DIAG>
Function
button/item
Switching
method
Corresponding setup
menu item
Setting
Description of setting
F1
WARN
For displaying the warning messages on the LCD monitor.
___
___
___
___
___
___
Toggle
FiPress
___
___
FiPress
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
F2
HOURS
For displaying the hour-meter on the LCD monitor.
___
___
___
___
___
F3
___
___
F4
___
___
F5
___
___
F6
___
___
Refer to the setup menu.
For calling the error log file operation menu.
___
F1 (SHIFT)
STEP
OFF
ON
No. 015
AUTO STEP
F2 (SHIFT)
CARD
___
___
___
___
___
___
F3 (SHIFT)
___
___
___
___
___
F4 (SHIFT)
___
___
F5 (SHIFT)
AL CLR
For clearing error log files.
___
F6 (SHIFT)
___
Concerning the setup menu item No.015 (AUTO
STEP) setting (default: OFF)
Up to 99 warning messages can be saved by the error
log function, and this setup menu item determines
what kind of save processing is to be conducted when
this storage capacity is exceeded.
OFF: 99 messages are set as the upper limit, and no
further messages of warnings that occur will be
saved.
ON: 99 messages are saved, and any further
message of a warnings that occurs is saved in
No.99. The warning messages already saved
are each shifted down by one number in
succession.
Messages saved when ON is selected as the setting
No. in which
message is
saved
No. in which
message is
saved
Saved warning
Saved warning
1/99
2/99
Warning 1
Warning 2
1/99
2/99
Warning 2
Warning 3
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
99/99
Warning 99
99/99
Warning 100
When up to 99 messages have been saved
and the 100th warning has occurred
56
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MENU
Function menus
<MENU>
These enable movement to the menu screens for
operations (adjustments, saving data onto or loading it
from the internal memory or IC cards) relating to the
SYSTEM and SETUP menus.
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
Function
button/item
Switching
method
Corresponding setup
menu item
Setting
Description of setting
F1
FILE
For calling the operation menu for saving the SYSTEM and
SETUP adjustment values (in the internal memory).
FiPress
FiPress
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
F2
CARD
For calling the operation menu for saving the SYSTEM and
SETUP adjustment values (onto the IC card).
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
F3
___
___
For calling the SYSTEM adjustment operation menu.
For calling the SETUP adjustment operation menu.
___
F4
SYSTEM
FiPress
FiPress
___
F5
SETUP
F6
___
F1 (SHIFT)
PF1 FT
For calling the PF1/function button assignment operation
menu.
FiPress
FiPress
FiPress
FiPress
FiPress
FiPress
F2 (SHIFT)
PF1 BK
For calling the PF1/function button assignment operation
menu.
F3 (SHIFT)
PF2 FT
For calling the PF2/function button assignment operation
menu.
F4 (SHIFT)
PF2 BK
For calling the PF2/function button assignment operation
menu.
F5 (SHIFT)
50P IN
For calling the 50-pin (input pin) assignment operation
menu.
F6 (SHIFT)
50P OT
For calling the 50-pin (output pin) assignment operation
menu.
*The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
57
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Function menus
<ASSEMBLE>
The ASSEMBLE editing mode is selected on this
menu screen.
IN point
OUT point
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
Automatic editing and manual editing
• When the editing mode has been selected (the
button is lighted), automatic editing or
ASSEM
manual editing can be performed even after the
ASSEMBLE screen has been exited.
• After the edit IN and OUT points have been
IN
OUT
registered (the
and
buttons are lighted),
the tape can be prerolled to an IN point or cued up
to an IN or OUT point even after the ASSEMBLE
screen has been exited.
Function
button/item
Switching
method
Corresponding setup
menu item
Setting
Description of setting
F1
ASSEM
Toggle
OFF
ON
For setting the editing mode to ON or OFF.
When the display is highlighted, the ASSEMBLE editing
mode is set to ON, and the ASSEM button lights.
___
F2
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
F3
___
F4
___
F5
___
F6
___
*The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
58
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
INSERT
Function menus
<INSERT>
The INSERT editing mode and editing channels are
selected on this menu screen.
Marker
OUT point
IN point
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
AUDIO IN point
AUDIO OUT point
Registering the edit points
After the edit IN and OUT points have been
IN
OUT
registered, the
and
buttons light.
Automatic editing and manual editing
• When the editing mode has been selected (the
INSERT
button is lighted), automatic editing or
manual editing can be performed even after the
INSERT screen has been exited.
• After the edit IN and OUT points have been
IN
OUT
registered (the
and
buttons are lighted),
the tape can be prerolled to an IN point or cued up
to an IN or OUT point even after the INSERT
screen has been exited.
Function
button/item
Switching
method
Corresponding setup
menu item
Setting
Description of setting
F1
V
Toggle
For setting the editing mode to ON or OFF and selecting
the editing channels.
___
___
With the exception of the function button (F1), two channels
are allocated.
F2
A5, A1
Use the SHIFT button to move the marker up or down, and
while specifying the channels, press the function buttons to
select them. Pressing the SHIFT button on other screens
serves a different purpose (screen switching) from its use
here.
For setting the editing mode to ON or OFF.
When one of the channel displays is highlighted, the
INSERT editing mode is set to ON, and the INSERT button
lights.
F3
A6, A2
F4
A7, A3
F5
A8, A4
F6
T, CUE
59
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Function menus
<SETUP MENU/SYSTEM MENU>
When the SETUP MENU or SYSTEM MENU opera-
tion menu is selected, a menu list appears on the
monitor, and the respective items can be set.
2. Changing the settings
1. In the menu item selection status, press the
ADJ dial.
At this time, the setting of the menu item
indicated by the menu item selection cursor
blinks on the monitor.
SETUP menu
Change mark
2. Turn the ADJ dial to select the setting. (Turn it
clockwise to move up through the settings and
counterclockwise to move down through the
settings.)
When the ADJ dial is pressed again, the menu
item selection status is restored.
<Notes>
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SYSTEM menu
Change mark
• Setting items which have submenus
SHIFT
A submenu is opened by pressing the
button. The same operations as the ones
described above are then used to change the
settings.
• Canceling individual items
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
F3
When
(CANCEL) is pressed, the setting
Monitor display menu
operation is canceled, and the item selection
status is restored.
Item selection cursor
Item number
3. Entering settings
Category
(After a setting has been entered, the menu
Setting number
operation is forcibly exited.)
F5
Press
(SET) to enter a setting.
4. Exiting the menu operation
F6
When the
(EXIT) button is pressed in the
menu item selection status, the menu operation is
exited, and the original operation screen is
restored.
However, if the
F6
(EXIT) button is pressed after
Setting
a setting has been changed without that setting
having been entered, a confirmation message will
be displayed.
Item name
Item number
Settings
Confirmation message
1. Selecting the menu items
Confirmation item
Description of setting
Select the menu item by turning the ADJ dial.
(The cursor is moved down when the dial is turned
clockwise and up when it is turned counter-
clockwise.)
EXIT confirmation
EXIT?
When an attempt has been
made to exit the menu
operation after a setting has
been changed without that
setting having been entered
F3: CANCEL
F5: SET(and EXIT)
F6: EXIT(without SET)
• Forward or reverse page scrolling (SETUP
menu only)
The menu list is organized by category, and the
pages can be scrolled in the forward or reverse
direction on a category by category basis.
<Note>
F1
F2
(: PREV),
<Note>
(; NEXT)
The “!” mark appears at the bottom left of the screen
when a setting has been changed.
The screen may continue to scroll for a few
moments after the ADJ dial has been turned.
60
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
SETUP MENU/
SYSTEM MENU
Function menus
<SETUP MENU/SYSTEM MENU>
Flow of setting changes
Press the ADJ dial.
Press SHIFT.
Submenu
Change the setting
Open the
screen.
Turn the ADJ dial.
F i F4 (item reset)
Turn the ADJ dial.
F i F4 (item reset)
Select the menu
item
Close the
screen.
F6 (EXIT)
Change the setting
Press the ADJ dial.
Turn the ADJ dial.
F i F4 (item reset),
FiF5 (SET)
SETUP MENU function buttons
Function
button/item
Switching
method
Corresponding setup
Setting
Description of setting
menu item
F1
: PREV
Press
Press
Press
Press
Press
Press
For scrolling the on-screen menu pages in the forward
direction.
___
___
F2
; NEXT
For scrolling the on-screen menu pages in the reverse
direction.
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
F3
CANCEL
___
F4
RESET
For resetting an item (while a setting is being changed).
For entering what has been set.
F5
SET
F6
EXIT
For exiting the special menu (and transferring to the original
menu). (Confirmation message provided)
F1 (SHIFT)
F2 (SHIFT)
F3 (SHIFT)
F4 (SHIFT)
F5 (SHIFT)
F6 (SHIFT)
___
___
___
___
___
SYSTEM MENU
function buttons
Function
button/item
Switching
method
Corresponding setup
menu item
Setting
Description of setting
F1
F2
___
___
___
___
___
F3
CANCEL
Press
___
___
___
___
___
F4
RESET
Press
Press
Press
For resetting an item (while a setting is being changed).
F5
SET
For entering what has been set.
___
___
___
___
F6
EXIT
For exiting the special menu (and transferring to the original
menu). (Confirmation message provided)
F1 (SHIFT)
F2 (SHIFT)
F3 (SHIFT)
F4 (SHIFT)
F5 (SHIFT)
F6 (SHIFT)
___
___
___
___
___
61
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Function menus
<FILE>
The current setting information, including the SETUP
menu contents, can be provided with titles and either
saved in or loaded from the backup memory in one of
4 variations.
Settings
1. Selecting the memory target
SHIFT
Press the
button.
The operation target switches alternately between
F1
F
When
(FILE) is pressed while the
button is held
C
1
4
VTR MEMORY
and VTR MEMORY
to
.
down on the <MENU> screen, the following function
menu is displayed.
2. Selecting the operation file in the selected
memory
Memory selection cursor
Memory name
The number of the currently selected file is
highlighted on the display. When the ADJ dial is
turned, the highlighting moves to the left or right,
enabling operation files to be selected.
3. Transferring files between memories
F2
After selecting the operation file, press
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
(LOAD).
1
The contents of files selected in VTR MEMORY
File title
(VTR)
4
C
to
can be transferred to VTR MEMORY
.
F
F2
When
is selected and
(LOAD) is pressed,
File title
(VTR)
File status
(VTR)
the factory setting mode is established.
F3
Alternatively, when
(SAVE) is pressed, the
C
contents of a file in VTR MEMORY
can be
File number
(VTR)
File number
(VTR)
1
transferred to a file selected in VTR MEMORY
to . (The titles are also transferred at the same
4
Warning
message
time.)
4. Editing the title of the selected file
Press the ADJ dial after selecting the operation
file.
C
• This VTR comes with VTR MEMORY
for storing
1
4
the current settings (*) and VTR MEMORY
for storing these settings as a backup.
• Each VTR MEMORY can be provided with a title.
to
The first digit of the title display area is highlighted,
and the file title can be edited.
• Data can be saved and loaded and titles can be
• To input a number, press the number keys.
• To input letters, tap the numbers keys until the
letter to be input appears while holding down
F
C
copied between VTR MEMORY
and VTR
1
4
MEMORY
to
.
• The file locking facility for preventing data from
being overwritten can be engaged for VTR
the
button.
More than one letter is allocated to each
number key.
1
4
MEMORY
to
.
• Turn the ADJ dial to move from one digit to the
next in the title display area.
• To enter the title, press the ADJ dial again.
<Notes>
* The term “settings” used here refers to all the settings on
the setup menus excluding the SYSTEM menu, what has
been registered in the PF1 and PF2 menu items, and the
contents of some of the function buttons.
• When the display screen has been switched or
C
Name of memory area
VTR MEMORY C
VTR MEMORY 1
VTR MEMORY 2
VTR MEMORY 3
VTR MEMORY 4
Initial title (up to 8 characters)
the
button has been pressed during title
CURRENT
USER1
USER2
USER3
USER4
editing, the editing enable status is canceled,
and the setting becomes invalid.
• A space can be input by pressing the
F
button
3
and
button.
62
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
FILE
Function menus
<FILE>
Settings
5. File overwrite inhibit facility
It is possible to lock the overwrite inhibit facility for
1
4
individual files in VTR MEMORY
to . Select
(LOCK) to lock
F5
the file to be locked, and press
it.
If
F5
(LOCK) is pressed again, the facility is
unlocked.
The locked or unlocked mode is displayed in the
file status.
≤
µ
[ : Unlocked status, : locked status]
Function
button/item
Switching
method
Corresponding setup
menu item
Setting
OFF
USER1
USER2
USER3
USER4
Description of setting
Refer to the setup menu.
F1
Press
A02
P.ON LOAD
P. LOAD
F2
LOAD
Press
Press
For downloading data to the current file.
For downloading data to the backup file.
___
___
___
(
)
F3
SAVE
___
F4
___
___
Press
___
___
___
___
___
___
___
F5
LOCK
For locking the backup file.
F6
EXIT
___
___
___
F1 (SHIFT)
F2 (SHIFT)
F3 (SHIFT)
F4 (SHIFT)
F5 (SHIFT)
F6 (SHIFT)
___
___
___
___
*The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
63
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Function menus
<PF1/PF2>
Up to 24 frequently used setup menu items can be
registered. The items are registered on the function
menus shown below. (No settings have been
registered before the VTR leaves the factory.)
4. Entering the menu items.
Press the ADJ dial.
The target of the ADJ dial operation returns to the
front panel. Whatever was selected in step 3
above is displayed for the registered menu
number and name.
To display one of the function menus, press
(PF1
F1
FT),
(PF1 BK),
(PF2 FT) or
(PF2 BK)
F4
F2
F3
while holding down the
SHIFT> screen.
button on the <MENU
F
5. To select a menu item for another function button,
repeat steps 1, 2, 3 and 4 above.
Selection marker
6. Saving the settings in a PF registration file
To save what has been set in the function buttons
Registered menu number
in a PF registration file, press
(SET).
F5
Menu name
If F6 (EXIT) is pressed without the settings
having been saved, the settings will be canceled.
When menu items are registered, they can be
called simply by pressing the PF1 or PF2 direct
menu button.
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
When
is pressed :
PF1
<PF1 FT>
When
Item selection cursor
is pressed after pressing
is pressed :
:
:
SHIFT
PF1
PF2
<PF1 BK>
When
Item number
Category
PF2
<PF2 FT>
When
Setting number
is pressed after pressing
SHIFT
<PF2 BK>
Clearing the menu items
1. Turn the ADJ dial to move the selection marker,
and select one of the function buttons
whose menu items are to be cleared.
to
F6
F1
Setting
2. Press
(RESET).
The registered menu
F4
Item name
number and name displays will now go blank.
Item number
3. To clear the menu items from other function
Registration
buttons, repeat steps 1 and 2 above.
1. Selecting the function buttons
Turn the ADJ dial to move the selection marker,
and select one of the function buttons to
4. To save what has been set in the function buttons
in a PF registration file, press
(SET).
F5
F1
F6
If
(EXIT) is pressed without the settings
F6
into which the menu items are to be registered.
having been saved, the above settings will be
canceled.
2. Entering the function button
Press the ADJ dial.
The display of the function button entered is
highlighted.
Clearing all the function button settings
Press
(RESET) while holding down the
button.
F4
F
All the registered menu number and name displays
will now go blank.
All the contents of the PF registration file are cleared.
(They cannot be restored.)
3. Selecting menu items
Turn the ADJ dial, and select the menu item for
the function button which was selected in step 1
above.
64
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
PF1/PF2
Function menus
<PF1/PF2>
Flow of function button registration
Press the
ADJ dial.
Open the
screen.
Select the function
Select the menu
items.
button to be registered.
Close the
screen.
F6 (EXIT)
Press the
ADJ dial.
F3 (cancel)
Turn the ADJ dial.
Turn the ADJ dial.
F1 (forward page scroll)
F2 (reverse page scroll)
F4 (one button reset)
F i F4 (all buttons reset)
F5 (settings entered)
PF1/PF2 function buttons
Function
button/item
Switching
method
Corresponding setup
menu item
Setting
Description of setting
F1
: PREV
Press
Press
Press
Press
For scrolling the on-screen menu pages in the forward
direction.
___
___
___
___
F2
; NEXT
For scrolling the on-screen menu pages in the reverse
direction.
___
___
F3
CANCEL
For releasing the menu item selection status.
F4
RESET
For clearing one button: what has been selected for the pin
by the individual reset selection marker is cleared.
___
___
For clearing all the buttons: what has been registered in all
the pins is deleted from the PF registration files.
FiPress
F5
SET
Press
Press
For entering the settings. (No confirmation message
provided)
___
___
___
___
F6
EXIT
For exiting the special menu (and transferring to the original
menu). (Confirmation message provided)
F1 (SHIFT)
F2 (SHIFT)
F3 (SHIFT)
F4 (SHIFT)
F5 (SHIFT)
F6 (SHIFT)
___
___
___
___
___
65
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Function menus
<PF1/PF2>
PF1/PF2 function button names
When SETUP menu items have been registered in the function buttons, the names of these function buttons are
displayed as set forth in the table below.
Setup menu
item No.
Name of setup menu
item
Setup menu
item No.
Name of setup menu
item
Function button name
Function button name
000
001
002
003
004
005
006
007
008
009
010
011
012
013
014
015
020
022
023
030
031
P-ROLL
ROLTIMEPRE
132
133
134
135
140
141
142
143
144
145
ROTA
MODEROTATE
LOCAL ENA
L ENA
KEY BEEP
KEY BP
AL BP
TAPE TIMER
REMAIN SEL
SYNCHRONIZESYNCR
SUPER
TIMER
REMAIN
ALARM BEEP
DET BEEP
DET BP
OUTPUT
OUTPUT
SUPER
DISPLY
C HPOS
C VPOS
VOLUMEVOLUME
AUDIO UNITY
CASSTT LIGHT
TC INPUT
DISPLAY SEL
CHARA H-POS
CHARA V-POS
CHARA
A UNI
CAS LT
TC IN
TYPEC
MONI C
TYPE
FRONT LCD
F LCD
MONI CONTROL
CU-ROLL
TIMECU-ROL
REC AJ
DET ST
DET AJ
STEP
200
202
204
205
206
207
208
209
212
PARA RUN
ID SEL
PR RUN
ID SEL
REC ADJUST
DET STOP
RS232C SEL
BAUD
RS232C
DET ADJUST
AUTO STOP
SYS FORMAT
PB FORMAT
FORMAT SEL
HD FREQUENCY
OUT REF
RATEBAND
R
DATA LENGTH
STOP BIT
DATA L
ST BIT
SYS FT
PB FT
PARITY
PARITY
RET AK
MSTR P
FMT SL
HD FRQ
OUTREF
RETURN ACK
MASTER PORT
300
301
302
303
304
305
306
307
308
309
310
311
312
320
321
322
323
324
IN/OUT DEL
HD FRQ
OUTREF
CONFI
100
101
102
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
118
131
SEARCH ENA
SHTL MAX
SEARCH
STL MX
F/R MX
REF AL
AT EE
NEGA FLASH
CONFI EDIT
FF.REW MAX
REF ALARM
AUTO EE SEL
EJECT EE SEL
EE MODE SEL
PLAY DELAY
CAP.LOCK
AUD EDIT IN
AUD EDIT OUT
AUTO ENTRY
CF ADJ SEL
AUD I
AUD O
AT ENT
CF ADJ
AF CUP
V F MX
V R MX
J F MX
EJ EE
EE MD
PL DLY
CAPSTN
AT REW
MEM ST
FRZ MD
R INH
AFTER CUE-UP
VAR FWD MAX
VAR REV MAX
JOG FWD MAX
JOG REV MAX
POSTROLL TM
EDIT RPLCE1
EDIT RPLCE2
EDIT RPLCE3
EDIT RPLCE4
EDIT RPLCEC
AUTO REW
MEMORY STOP
FRZ MODE SEL
REC INH
J R MX
POSROL
RPLCE1
RPLCE2
RPLCE3
RPLCE4
RPLCEC
REC INH LAMP
EJECT SW INH
EJECT LAMP
SP MODE INH
PAGE MODE
INH LP
EJ SW
INH LP
SP MD
PAGE
66
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
PF1/PF2
Function menus
<PF1/PF2>
Setup menu
item No.
Name of setup menu
item
Setup menu
item No.
Name of setup menu
item
Function button name
Function button name
400
401
402
403
STILL TIMER
STILL
634
635
636
637
638
639
640
641
642
650
651
653
654
655
656
658
659
660
661
662
663
664
665
670
671
672
IN673
674
675
676
680
681
684
685
686
687
688
695
480pHO
480pSO
480iHD
480iSD
MODEIUC
IUC RH
IUC RV
IUC EH
IUC EV
480p#HD_OUT
480p#SD_OUT
480i#HD_OUT
480i#SD_OUT
SRC PROTECT
DRUM STDBY
STOP PROTECT
SRC PT
DRUM
STP PT
IN
U/C
MD
500
501
502
503
504
505
506
507
508
509
510
511
512
513
514
515
516
517
VITC BLANK
VITC POS-1
VITC POS-2
VI BLK
VI PS1
VI PS2
I U/C RESP H
I U/C RESP V
I U/C ENH H
I U/C ENH V
STYLESTYLE
TCG
MODETCG
MODERUN
TCG RG
REG MD
SOURCETC
MD
MD
RUN
TCG REGEN
REGEN MODE
TC
HUE STYLE (SD)
Y LVL (HD)
HUE S
Y HD
SRC
Pb LVL (HD)
Pr LVL (HD)
BK LVL (HD)
Y LVL (SD)
Pb HD
Pr HD
BK HD
Y SD
BINARY GP
PHASE CORR
TCG CF FLAG
DF
BINARY
P CORR
TG CFF
MODEDF
MOD
Pb LVL (SD)
Pr LVL (SD)
BK LVL (SD)
V LEVEL
Pb SD
Pr SD
BK SD
V LV
TC OUT REF
VITC OUT
HD EMBD VITC
HD EMBD LTC
TC OUT ADV
TCG OUT
TC REF
VITC O
ENBD V
ENBD L
TC ADV
TCG O
C LEVEL
C LV
HUE (C PHASE)
SETUP (BK) LVL
BRIGHT
HUE
SUP LV
BR
600
601
602
603
604
605
606
620
621
622
623
624
625
626
627
628
629
630
631
632
633
VIDEO IN SEL
VIDEO INT SG
SDI
VID IN
R-BRIGHT
R-BR
INT SG
B-BRIGHT
B-BR
IN
MODESDI
CONTRAST
R-CONTRAST
B-CONTRAST
BLK CLIP
CT
V-MUTE SEL
FREEZE SEL
INTERPOLATE
SD MON O SEL
DOWNCON
UPCONV
V-MUTE
FRZ SL
INTPLT
SD MOS
R-CT
B-CT
B LIP
CC (F1) BLANK
CC (F2) BLANK
EDH (SD)
CC1 BK
CC2 BK
EDH SD
ESR SD
CCR SD
SDI IX
CC REC
MODEDW
MODEUP
D/C RH
CON
CON
D/C RESP H
D/C RESP V
U/C RESP H
U/C RESP V
D/C ENH H
ESR MODE (SD)
CCR MODE (SD)
SDI INDEX O
CC REC
D/C RV
U/C RH
U/C RV
D/C EH
D/C EV
U/C EH
U/C EV
1080HO
1080SO
720pHO
720pSO
BLANK
LINEBK
L
D/C ENH V
U/C ENH H
U/C ENH V
1080i#HD_OUT
1080i#SD_OUT
720p#HD_OUT
720p#SD_OUT
67
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Function menus
<PF1/PF2>
Setup menu
item No.
Name of setup menu
item
Setup menu
item No.
Name of setup menu
item
Function button name
Function button name
700
701
702
703
704
705
706
707
708
709
710
711
712
713
714
715
716
717
718
719
720
721
722
723
724
725
726
727
728
729
730
731
732
733
734
735
736
737
738
739
740
741
CH1 IN LV
CH2 IN LV
CH3 IN LV
CH4 IN LV
CUE IN LV
CH1 OUT LV
CH2 OUT LV
CH3 OUT LV
CH4 OUT LV
CUE OUT LV
MONIL OUT LV
MONIR OUT LV
MONI OUT
CH1 IN SEL
CH2 IN SEL
CH3 IN SEL
CH4 IN SEL
CH5 IN SEL
CH6 IN SEL
CH7 IN SEL
CH8 IN SEL
D IN SEL12
D IN SEL34
D IN SEL56
D IN SEL78
REC CH1
A1 ILV
A2 ILV
A3 ILV
A4 ILV
AC ILV
A1 OLV
A2 OLV
A3 OLV
A4 OLV
AC OLV
ML OLV
MR OLV
MONI O
A1 IN
742
743
744
745
746
747
748
749
750
751
752
753
754
755
756
757
758
759
760
761
762
763
790
791
CH5 CUE SEL
CH6 CUE SEL
CH7 CUE SEL
CH8 CUE SEL
MONI CH SEL
MON AUTO SEL
MONI SEL INH
AUDIO PB VR
ANA CH1 SEL
ANA CH2 SEL
ANA CH3 SEL
ANA CH4 SEL
SD SDI CH1 SL
SD SDI CH2 SL
SD SDI CH3 SL
SD SDI CH4 SL
JOG PROC
A5 CSL
A6 CSL
A7 CSL
A8 CSL
MON CH
MON AT
MS INH
APB VR
AA1 SL
AA2 SL
AA3 SL
AA4 SL
SSA1SL
SSA2SL
SSA3SL
SSA4SL
JOG P
A2 IN
A3 IN
A4 IN
A5 IN
DV PB ATT
DV ATT
R PTMT
A INSG
A RC
A6 IN
REC PT MUTE
AUDIO INT SG
AUD RATE CON
METER SCALE
CUE REC VOL
CUE PB VOL
A7 IN
A8 IN
DIN 12
DIN 34
DIN 56
DIN 78
REC A1
REC A2
REC A3
REC A4
REC A5
REC A6
REC A7
REC A8
RECCUE
M SCL
CR VOL
CP VOL
A02
P.ON LOAD
P.LOAD
REC CH2
REC CH3
REC CH4
REC CH5
REC CH6
REC CH7
REC CH8
REC CUE
PB
FADEPB
FD
HD EMBD AUD
SD EMBD AUD
MONI MIX
HDEM A
SDEM A
M MIX
CH1 CUE SEL
CH2 CUE SEL
CH3 CUE SEL
CH4 CUE SEL
A1 CSL
A2 CSL
A3 CSL
A4 CSL
68
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
CARD
Function menus
<CARD>
The settings and information can be saved onto or
Warning message 1
Warnings concerning the IC card are displayed here.
NO CARD
loaded from the IC card memory. When
(CARD)
F2
is pressed on the <MENU> screen while the
button
F
is held down, the function menu shown below is
displayed.
The IC card has not been inserted.
UNFORMATTED CARD
The IC card is not formatted.
HD150 FORMAT!
This card was formatted by the AJ-HD150.
HD1500 FORMAT!
[MENU/ERROR LOG/MULTI CUE]
Memory name
Memory selection
cursor
This card was formatted by the AJ-HD1500.
Warning message 2
BATTERY!
This appears when the battery inside the IC card has
no charge left. It signifies that it is time to replace the
battery.
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
Warning message 1
PROTECT!
The IC card protection is set to ON.
SYSTEM MENU/SETUP MENU/50PIN ASSIGN
File title (CARD)
File number
File title (VTR)
File status
File number
(VTR)
(CARD)
File status (CARD)
File status (VTR)
Blank
No storage files are present.
- - - - -
Storage files are present. The target file is in the
(Unlocked status) unlocked status.
≤
Storage files are present. The target file is in the
(Locked status) locked status.
µ
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
File status (CARD)
File status (VTR)
Warning message 2
MULTI CUE
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
ERROR LOG
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
<Notes>
• IC cards are not compatible with other VTR models.
• The IC cards which can be used are the 68-pin two-
piece type of SRAM cards (64KB or more) with
replaceable battery. Model number BN-064HSR is
recommended.
69
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Function menus
<CARD>
[MENU/ERROR LOG/MULTI CUE]
• The SETUP MENU (current, USER1 to USER4)
and SYSTEM MENU settings, 50PIN ASSIGN
registration data, MULTI CUE registered points and
ERROR LOG data in the VTR MEMORY in this
VTR can be saved in and loaded from the IC cards.
• Titles can be provided for all the data files, and
when the files are saved or loaded, the titles are
also copied at the same time.
• For those data files which have been saved in the
IC card, a file lock facility can be engaged to
prevent the data in those files from being
overwritten.
IC card data layout Lock
VTR memory data layout Lock
SETUP MENU
50 PIN ASSIGN
SYSTEM MENU
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
SETUP MENU Current
(what has been
registered for
the PF1, PF2
k
≤
≤
≤
≤
USER1
USER2
menu items,
USER3
≤
≤
≤
<> contents of
USER4
some function
buttons)
50 PIN ASSIGN Current
≤
Settings
<>
1. Selecting the targeted memory
Press the
button.
SHIFT
The operation target is switched alternately
between the IC CARD MEMORY and VTR
MEMORY.
SYSTEM MENU Current
≤
2. Selecting the operation files inside the
selected memory
The number of the currently selected file is
highlighted.
Turn the ADJ dial to select the file to be operated.
• For SYSTEM MENU, SETUP MENU and 50PIN
ASSIGN
<>
The details of the registration status display for
the IC CARD MEMORY are automatically
switched depending on whether S (SYSTEM
MENU), C1234 (SETUP MENU) or P (50PIN
ASSIGN) is selected at the VTR MEMORY
side.
IC card data layout Lock
VTR memory data layout Lock
CUEMULTI
MULTI
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Current
CUE
k
≤
<>
3. Transferring files between memories
>
• VTR MEMORY IC CARD MEMORY
First select the operation file, and then press
(SAVE).
F2
>
• IC CARD MEMORY VTR MEMORY
ERROR LOG
ERROR LOG
Current
k
First select the operation file, and then press
(LOAD).
F3
<Note>
The title is also transferred at the same time.
≤
<>
70
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
CARD
Function menus
<CARD>
4. Editing the title of a selected file
First select the operation file, and then press the
ADJ dial.
5. File overwrite inhibit facility
It is possible to lock the overwrite inhibit facility for
individual files in the IC CARD MEMORY.
• Locking a file
The first digit of the title display area is highlighted,
indicating that the file title can now be edited.
• To input a number, press the number keys.
• To input letters, tap the numbers keys until the
letter to be input appears while holding down
F
Select the file to be locked, and press
(LOCK).
• Unlocking a file
F5
Press
(LOCK) again.
F5
the
button.
<Note>
More than one letter is allocated to each
number key.
The locked or unlocked status is displayed in the
file status.
≤
µ
• Press the ADJ dial to move from one digit to the
next on the title display area.
• To enter the title, press the ADJ dial again.
<Notes>
[ : Unlocked status, : locked status]
• When the display screen has been switched or
C
the
button has been pressed during title
editing, the editing enable status is canceled,
and the setting becomes invalid.
• A space can be input by pressing the
F
button
3
and
button.
Function
button/item
Switching
method
Corresponding setup
menu item
Setting
Description of setting
F1
FORMAT
For formatting the IC card.
FiPress
___
___
___
___
___
F2
SAVE<
Press
Press
For transferring data to the IC card files.
For transferring data from the IC card files.
For deleting IC card files.
___
___
___
F3
LOAD>
F4
DELETE
FiPress
F5
LOCK
Press
For locking IC card files or VTR MEMORY files.a
___
___
___
___
F6
EXIT
___
___
F1 (SHIFT)
F2 (SHIFT)
F3 (SHIFT)
F4 (SHIFT)
F5 (SHIFT)
F6 (SHIFT)
___
___
___
___
___
71
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Function menus
<50P IN/OUT ASSIGN>
Using the front panel controls and on-screen menus,
functions are registered into the input pins of the
parallel remote (50PIN) connector and the statuses
are registered into its output pins.
Pins in which functions can be registered
IN pins: Pins 6 to 20, 22, 23, 25
OUT pins: Pin 21, 24, pins 32 to 46, 48
All other pins are reserved and cannot be changed.
When
(50P IN) or
(50P OT) is pressed while
F6
F5
the
button is held down on the <MENU SHIFT>
F
IN pins
OUT pins
menu, the function menu shown below appears, and
functions can be registered or deleted.
Selection marker
21
24
26
Range of pins to which any
items can be assigned
<Power>
1
2
REC
27 REC
28 PLAY
29 FF
30 REW
31 STOP
32
Registered item name
Registered value
PLAY
FF
3
4
REW
STOP
5
6
:
l
:
Range of pins to which
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
l
any items can be
assigned
Range of pins to which
any items can be
assigned
;
20
22
23
25
;
46
48
Item selection cursor
Item number
Category
Setting number
47 <GND>
49 <GND>
50 <GND>
Items which can be registered in the input and
output pins
Items identical to the setup menu items can be
registered in both the input and output pins. In
addition, there are a set of special items can be also
registered in the input pins and another set for the
output pins.
Setting
Item name
Item number
<Note>
Registered item names
System menu and submenu items cannot be
registered.
Setup menu items and 50PIN special menu items can
be registered in the parallel remote connector pins,
and the names of these menu items are displayed.
Item no.
Registration in input pins
Registration in output pins
000
100
200
300
400
500
600
700
Registered values
One setting for the registered menu item is displayed
in each of the pins.
When active signals are input to the IN pins in which
the setup menu items mentioned above have been
registered, the settings for the registered menu items
take effect inside the VTR.
When the settings for the registered menu items tally
with the registered values, active signals are output
from the registered OUT pins.
Setup menu list
B00
C00
Special IN menu list
<No display>
<No display>
Special OUT menu list
72
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
50P IN/OUT
ASSIGN
Function menus
<50P IN/OUT ASSIGN>
Registering functions in the input pins/Active inputs
Registering functions in the output pins/Active outputs
Resetting all the items and values
Press
(RESET) while holding down the
button.
F4
F
All the registered item names and registered values
are now set to the factory settings. (These settings
cannot be restored.)
1. Selecting the 50-pin connector pins
Turn the ADJ dial to move the selection marker and
select the pin of the 50-pin connector into which the
menu item is to be registered.
Special IN menu list
No.
SUPER
DISPLAY
2. Entering the 50-pin connector pins
Description of setting
Press the ADJ dial.
The entered 50-pin connector pin display is highlighted.
Functions not featured on the setup menua
B00
STBY ON
For transferring to the STANDBY ON mode.
3. Selecting the menu item
Turn the ADJ dial and select the menu item for the pin
of the 50-pin connector which was selected in step 1
above.
B01
STBY OFF
For transferring to the STANDBY OFF mode.
For alternately transferring to the STANDBY ON
B02
4. Entering the menu item
Press the ADJ dial.
STBY ONOFF and OFF mode.
B03
EJECT
For transferring to the EJECT mode.
The on-screen setting display now blinks.
B04
CUE
For prerolling the tape to the IN point when the
IN point has been registered; for prerolling the
tape to the current point when the IN point has
not been registered.
5. Selecting the setting
Turn the ADJ dial and select the setting for the
menu item which was selected in step 3 above.
B05
IN SET
For registering the edit IN point.
6. Entering the setting
Press the ADJ dial
.
What is to be operated by the ADJ dial returns to the
front panel. Whatever was selected in step 3 is
displayed as the registered item name and whatever was
selected in step 5 is displayed as the registered value.
B06
STILL
For transferring to the still picture (STILL) mode.
The 9-pin connector functions.
B07
422 REM ON
B08
422 REM OFF
The 9-pin connector does not function.
7. To select menu items and settings for other 50-pin
connector pins, repeat steps 1 to 6.
B09
TC EXT
For returning TC SOURCE to the previous EXT
mode.
(No switching occurs if the EXT mode is
currently established.)
8. Saving the data in the 50-pin registration file
To save what has been set in the 50-pin connector in
F5
the 50-pin registration file, press
(SET).
(EXIT) is pressed without the above settings
have been saved, those settings will be canceled.
B10
For switching TC SOURCE to INT and TCG
F6
If
TC INT AUTO MODE to AUTO.
B11
TC EXT_L
REG
For switching TC SOURCE to EXT_L and TCG
MODE to REGEN.
Clearing
SRC PROTECT and STOP PROTECT settings switched simultaneously
1. Turn the ADJ dial to move the selection marker and select the
pin of the 50-pin connector whose menu item is to be cleared.
B20
For switching the tape protection mode operation to
half-loading in the event that the VTR has been left
standing in the STOP mode or the STILL mode while
any of the search modes (JOG, VAR or SHTL) was
established.
PROTECT
HALF
2.
F4
Press
(RESET). The registered item name
and registered value displays now go blank.
B21
PROTECT
T-REL
For switching the tape protection mode operation to
tension release when the VTR has been left standing
in the STOP mode or the STILL mode while any of the
search modes (JOG, VAR or SHTL) was established.
3. To clear the menu items in other 50-pin connector
pins, repeat steps 1 and 2.
4.
To save what has been set in the 50-pin connector in
F5
the 50-pin registration file, press
(SET).
(EXIT) is pressed without the above settings
have been saved, those settings will be canceled.
F6
If
73
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Function menus
<50P IN/OUT ASSIGN>
Special IN menu list (continued)
No.
No.
SUPER
DISPLAY
SUPER
DISPLAY
Description of setting
Down-conversion status 3
Description of setting
C16
DC3
UPCON MODE and DOWNCON MODE settings switched simultaneously
B22
UD FIT_V
For switching the picture angle during down-conversion to
letter box and the picture angle during up-conversion to the
top/bottom cut status in the vertical direction.
C17
UC1
Up-conversion status 1
Up-conversion status 2
Up-conversion/down-conversion status 1
Up-conversion/down-conversion status 2
Up-conversion/down-conversion status 3
Error status 0
C18
UC2
B23
UD FIT_H
For switching the picture angle during down-
conversion to the side cut mode and the picture angle
during up-conversion to the side panel mode.
C19
UD1
B24
UD FIT_HV
For switching the picture angle during down-
conversion to the squeeze mode and the picture
angle during up-conversion to the stretch mode.
C20
UD2
C21
UD3
Special OUT menu list
C22
ERR0
No.
SUPER
DISPLAY
Description of setting
EJECT status
C23
ERR1
Error status 1
C00
EJECT
C24
Error status 2
ERR2
C01
STANDBY ON status
STBY ON
C26
CH GREEN
Channel condition green LED
Channel condition amber LED
Channel condition red LED
Servo lock LED
C02
CUE
CUE-UP completed status
STILL status
C27
CH AMBER
C03
STILL
C28
CH RED
C04
Status in which the front panel STOP button is
PANEL STOP pressed down
C29
SERVO LOCK
C05
Status of whether to inhibit overwrite during
PRE CTL
normal recording
C30
Video UNITY LED
V UNITY
C06
9-pin connector function status
422 REM ON
C31
Audio UNITY LED
A UNITY
C07
REMOTE
50-pin connector function status
Recording inhibit status 1
Recording inhibit status 2
Tape recording inhibit status 1
Tape recording inhibit status 2
TC input status 1
C08
REC INH1
C09
REC INH2
C10
CAS INH1
C11
CAS INH2
C12
TC SRC1
C13
TC input status 2
TC SRC2
C14
DC1
Down-conversion status 1
Down-conversion status 2
C15
DC2
74
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
50P IN/OUT
ASSIGN
Function menus
<50P IN/OUT ASSIGN>
The statuses established by a multiple number of pins
in the special OUT menu list are displayed. Pin status
“1” signifies “active low” and “0” signifies “open.”
Up-conversion statuses
C17
UC1
C18
UC2
Up-conversion status
0
0
1
0
1
0
Stretch mode
Side panel mode
Top and bottom cut in vertical direction
Error statuses
C22
C23
C24
Error status
ERR0 ERR1 ERR2
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
SERVO NOT LOCKED (priority level 1)
SERVO LOCKED (priority level 4)
HIGH ERROR (amber) (priority level 3)
HIGH ERROR (red) (priority level 2)
Up-conversion down-conversion statuses
C19 C20 C21
UD1 UD2 UD3
Down-conversion
status
Up-conversion
status
0
0
0
1
0
0
Squeeze mode
Side cut mode
Stretch mode
Side panel mode
TC input statuses
Top and bottom cut
in vertical direction
1
1
0
1
0
1
Letter box mode
C12
TC SRC1
C13
TC SRC2
TC input status
Any other combination
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
External SLTC
External LTC
External SVITC (or external VITC with SD input)
INT
Tape recording inhibit statuses
C10
CAS INH1
C11
CAS INH2
Tape recording inhibit status
0
0
0
1
Cassette recording enabled
Cassette accidental erasure prevented
Recording inhibit statuses
C08
C09
Recording inhibit statuses
REC INH1 REC INH2
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Overwriting prohibited during normal recording
All recording onto cassette prohibited
Recording inhibit mode other than the 2 above modes
Recording onto cassette enabled
Down-conversion statuses
C14
DC1
C15
DC2
C16
DC3
Down-conversion status
Squeeze mode
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
Side cut modea
Letter box mode
14:9
13:9
75
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Function menus
<50P IN/OUT ASSIGN>
Flow of registration
Turn the ADJ dial.
F1 (forward page scroll)
F2 (reverse page scroll)
Status in which selected 50-
pin connector pin menu item
selection is enabled
Press the ADJ dial.
Open the
Press the ADJ dial.
Status in which regis-
tered 50-pin connector
pin selection is enabled
screen.
F3 (cancel)
Close the
screen.
F6 (EXIT)
Status in which selected
menu item setting
selection is enabled
Turn the ADJ dial.
F4 (one pin reset)
F i F4 (all pins reset)
F5 (settings entered)
Turn the ADJ dial.
Press the ADJ dial.
F3 (cancel)
50P IN/OUT ASSIGN function buttons
Function
button/item
Switching
method
Corresponding setup
menu item
Setting
Description of setting
F1
: PREV
Press
Press
Press
For scrolling the on-screen menu pages in the forward
direction.
___
___
___
___
F2
; NEXT
For scrolling the on-screen menu pages in the reverse
direction.
___
___
F3
CANCEL
For releasing the menu item selection status.
F4
RESET
For resetting one pin: what has been selected for the pin
selected by the individual reset selection marker is cleared.
Press
___
___
For resetting all the pins: what has been registered in all the pins is
set to the factory settings and set in the 50-pin registration file.
FiPress
F5
SET
Press
For registering the file; all the function button settings are
saved in the 50-pin registration file.
___
___
___
___
F6
EXIT
Press
For exiting the special menu (and transferring to the original
menu).
F1 (SHIFT)
F2 (SHIFT)
F3 (SHIFT)
F4 (SHIFT)
F5 (SHIFT)
F6 (SHIFT)
___
___
___
___
76
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
50P IN/OUT
ASSIGN
Function menus
<50P IN/OUT ASSIGN>
50-pin assignment factory settings
Pin
no.
I/O
Pin
no.
I/O
Setting item
Setting item
1
I
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
O
O
REC
CUE STATUS
2
I
PLAY
REMOTE STATUS
3
I
O
FF
DET STOP STATUS
4
I
O
REW
PRE CTL DETECTED STATUS
LOCAL ENABLE STATUS
STANDBY ON STATUS
5
I
O
STOP
6
I
O
___
___
422 REMOTE ON
7
I
GND
O
8
I
___
9
I
GND
GND
422 REMOTE OFF
LOCAL ENABLE
EJECT
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
I
I
__
” denotes that nothing is subject to control or to a status.
“
I
IN SET
I
REC INH ALL
REC INH PRE
LOCAL DISABLE
TC EXT
<Notes>
I
• For a command, input TTL level signals; for an
active low edge, input an electrical signal of 100 ms
or more.
• For a status, a maximum open collector and sink
current of 6 mA is output.
I
I
I
TC INT&TCG MODE AUTO
___
I
I
___
I
O
I
STNDBY ON/OFF
ERR0 STATUS
DET STOP ON
CUE
I
O
I
ERR1 STATUS
DET STOP OFF
Power
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
REC STATUS
PLAY STATUS
FF STATUS
REW STATUS
STOP STATUS
422 REMOTE STATUS
EJECT STATUS
ERR2 STATUS
TC SRC1 STATUS
TC SRC2 STATUS
___
___
REC INH1 STATUS
REC INH2 STATUS
77
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
System menus
Video output signal adjustments
The control matrix for the adjustments is shown in the table below.
No./Item
Description of setting
This enables one of a number of different signals
When “CMPNT” has been selected as the setup menu item
No.650 (STYLE) setting
00
WFM SEL
to be output from the VIDEO OUT
connector.
2
output
Setting
06:
ENCODER V LEVEL 654: Pb LVL (HD) 659: Pb LVL (SD)
Adjustment item
05:
653: Y LVL (HD) 658: Y LVL (SD)
0000
0001
0002
0003
0004
0005 ENV_L
0006 ENV_R
<Notes>
CTL
TC
VIDEO
RF_L
RF_R
:
:
:
:
:
:
The CTL signal is output.
The time code signal is output.
The video output signal is output.
The PB L RF signal is output.
The PB R RF signal is output.
The PB L ENV signal is output.
SEL
CTRL
655: Pr LVL (HD)
660: Pr LVL (SD)
656: BK LVL (HD) 661: BK LVL (SD)
REMOTE
HD
External encoder
remote controller
No adjustments
possible
:
The PB L ENV signal is output.
SD
No adjustments
possible
External encoder
remote controller
• The setting can be changed at any time without
being affected by the system menu item No.30
(MENU LOCK) setting.
• The output signals during normal playback
virtually maintain the levels given below.
BOTH
External encoder
remote controller
External encoder
remote controller
LOCAL
BOTH
HD
SD
AJ-HD1700
AJ-HD1700
CTL:
0.1 to.3Vp-p
TC: 0.6Vp-p
BOTH
HD
VIDEO: 1.0Vp-p
External encoder remote
controller/AJ-HD1700
AJ-HD1700
05
For setting whether to perform the various
adjustments for the video output signals using this
VTR or using an external encoder remote
controller.
SD
External encoder remote
controller/AJ-HD1700
AJ-HD1700
ENCODER
SEL
BOTH
External encoder remote
controller/AJ-HD1700
External encoder remote
controller/AJ-HD1700
0000 REMOTE:
The various adjustments for the video output
signals are performed by an external encoder
remote controller.
External encoder remote controller: Only adjustments of the
external encoder remote controller are performed.
AJ-HD1700: Only adjustments of the setup menu items are
performed.
0001 LOCAL:
The various adjustments for the video output
signals are performed using this VTR.
0002 BOTH:
External encoder remote controller/AJ-HD1700: Adjustments can
be performed from both the external encoder remote controller and
setup menus.
The various adjustments for the video output
signals are performed using both this VTR and
an external encoder remote controller.
<Note>
Use the AJ-ER50, an optional accessory, as the external encoder
remote controller. However, its VIDEO PHASE and SYNC PHASE
controls will not work.
06
For selecting what is to be controlled when
the video output level is to be adjusted by an
external encoder remote controller.
When “CMPST” has been selected as the setup menu item
No.650 (STYLE) setting
V LEVEL
CTRL
0000
HD:
Setting
06:
ENCODER V LEVEL 663: C LEVEL
Adjustment item
The HD video output level can be adjusted.
0001
The SD video output level can be adjusted.
0002 BOTH:
Both the HD and SD video output levels can be
adjusted.
05:
662: V LEVEL
SD:
SEL
CTRL
664: HUE ( or C PHASE)
665: SETUP LVL (or BK LVL)
REMOTE
HD
External encoder remote
controller
SD
BOTH
HD
LOCAL
BOTH
SD
AJ-HD1700
BOTH
HD
External encoder remote
controller/AJ-HD1700
SD
BOTH
External encoder remote controller: Only adjustments of the external
encoder remote controller are performed.
AJ-HD1700: Only adjustments of the setup menu items are performed.
External encoder remote controller/AJ-HD1700: Adjustments can be
performed from both the external encoder remote controller and setup
menus.
<Note>
Use the MT-200 (manufactured by Musashi and recommended by
Panasonic) as the external encoder remote controller. However, its
VIDEO PHASE, SYNC PHASE and SC PHASE controls will not work.
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
78
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
System menus
No./Item
Description of setting
No./Item
Description of setting
12
For adjusting the system phase of the HD SDI output.
When the button is pressed, the display transfers to
the submenu screen; press the button again to
return the display from the submenu screen.
15
For adjusting the system phase of the VIDEO OUT.
When the
the submenu screen; press the
return the display from the submenu screen.
button is pressed, the display transfers to
SHIFT
SHIFT
SYS H
(HD)*UP
VO SYS
H (SD)*DW
button again to
SHIFT
SHIFT
Submenu screen
Submenu screen
00
For adjusting the system phase of the HD SDI
output in 1H steps.
00
For adjusting the VIDEO OUT system phase in 1H
steps.
j: To advance the phase. i: To delay the phase.
j: To advance the phase. i: To delay the phase.
COARSE
COARSE
0000
:
j5H
:
0000
:
j5H
:
<Note>
<Note>
This setting remains unchanged
even when the factory setting
operation is performed.
This setting remains unchanged
even when the factory setting
operation is performed.
0005
:
0010
0H
:
5H
0005
:
0010
0H
:
5H
01
For adjusting the HD SDI output system
phase in 13.5ns steps.
01
For adjusting the VIDEO OUT system phase in
37ns steps.
j: To advance the phase. i: To delay the phase.
j: To advance the phase. i: To delay the phase.
FINE
FINE
<59/60Hz>
0000 j1100
<23/24Hz>
0000 j1375
<50Hz, 25Hz (HD,SD)>
<59/60Hz, 23/24Hz>
<50Hz, 25Hz (HD, SD)>
0000
1320
j
0000
:
0858
:
j858
0000
:
0864
:
j864
:
1100
:
:
0
:
:
1375
:
:
0
:
:
:
:
0
:
0
1320
:
0
:
:
:
2200
1100
2700
1375
2640
1320
1716
858
1728
864
<Note>
<Note>
This setting remains unchanged even when the
factory setting operation is performed.
This setting remains unchanged even when the
factory setting operation is performed.
14
For adjusting the system phase over a total
16
For adjusting the system phase of the SD SDI.
d
o
variable range of more than 180 .
When the
the submenu screen; press the
return the display from the submenu screen.
button is pressed, the display transfers to
SHIFT
j: To advance the phase. i: To delay the phase.
SYS SC
(SD)*DW
SD SYS
H (SD)*DW
button again to
SHIFT
<59/60Hz, 23/24Hz>
<50Hz, 25Hz (HD, SD)
Submenu screen
0000
:
0108
:
j108
0000
j115
00
For adjusting the SD SDI system phase in 1H
steps.
j: To advance the phase. i: To delay the phase.
:
0
:
:
0
0115
COARSE
:
:
:
0000
:
0005
:
j5H
:
0H
:
0216
108
0230
115
<Note>
<Note>
This setting remains unchanged
even when the factory setting
operation is performed.
This setting remains unchanged even when the
factory setting operation is performed.
0010
5H
01
For adjusting the SD SDI system phase in 37ns
steps for 480i outputs and in 54ns steps for 480p
outputs.
FINE
j: To advance the phase. i: To delay the phase.
<59/60Hz, 23/24Hz>
<50Hz, 25Hz (HD, SD)>
0000
:
0858
:
j858
0000
:
0864
:
j864
:
0
:
:
0
:
1716
858
1728
864
<Note>
This setting remains unchanged even when the
factory setting operation is performed.
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
*UP: This is for HD outputs (during HD tape playback or up-
conversion outputs).
*DW:This is for SD outputs (during SD tape playback or down-
conversion outputs).
79
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
System menus
No./Item
Description of setting
No./Item
Description of setting
18
SCH (SD)*DW
Submenu screen
For adjusting the SCH phase.
When the button is pressed, the display transfers to
the submenu screen; press the button again to
return the display from the submenu screen.
30
MENU LOCK
For selecting whether to set or release the
system file lock mode.
SHIFT
0000
0001
OFF
ON
:
:
Lock released (changes enabled)
Lock set (changes prohibited)
SHIFT
<Note>
Even when “ON” is selected, the data will be overwritten
when the system file has been set to LOAD from the IC
card.
00
o
For adjusting the SCH phase in 90 steps
(The SC phase changes, and the H phase remains
unchanged.)
COARSE
0000:
0001:
0002:
0003:
0
90
180
270
01
For adjusting the SCH phase over a total variable
o
range of more than d45 .
j: To advance the phase. i: To delay the phase.
(The SC phase changes, and the H phase remains
unchanged.)
FINE
0000
:
0032
:
j32
:
0
:
0064
32
20
AV PHASE
For adjusting the audio output phase in relation to
the video output phase in 20.8¨s steps.
j
:
:
The audio output phase is advanced in relation to
the video output phase.
The audio output phase is delayed in relation to
the video output phase.
i
0000
:
0100
:
j100
:
0
:
0200
100
25
For selecting the system frequency.
0: The 59.94 Hz or 60 Hz system frequency is selected.
1: The 50 Hz system frequency is selected.
2: The 23.98 Hz or 24 Hz system frequency is selected.
3: The 25 Hz system frequency is selected.
However, with SD SDI and video output signals, there
is a delay of approximately one field compared with
the HD SDI output.
*System switching
• Some of the system menu and setup menu items each have
SYSTEM
FREQ*
different settings for different operation modes (59/60 Hz, 50
Hz, 23/24 Hz and 25 Hz (HD or SD)). These settings are
saved separately.
(This concerns those items whose settings were described
for each operation mode on the system menu and setup
menu tables.)
4: The 25 Hz system frequency is selected.
However, HD SDI output is muted.
• For further details, refer to “How to switch the system
0003
0001*
0002
0003
0004
59/60
50*
23/24
25 (HD)
25 (SD)
frequency” on page 105.
* The asterisk denotes the
• Since this VTR becomes a playback-only unit when the
23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD or SD) mode has been selected,
the functions relating to EE, recording and editing are all
set to the inhibited status. Neither is it possible to select
CTL in such a case.
factory
setting
for
AJ-
HD1700E
59/60 Hz mode: Status in which “0” (59/60) has been
selected
(The related menus and function buttons are not
displayed, and operation is prohibited.)
50 Hz mode:
Status in which “1” (50) has been
selected
23/24 Hz mode: Status in which “2” (23/24) has been
k
For the instant when the tape begins to run at the 1
selected
speed such as when it starts playing from the STOP
status, the image is disrupted and the sound is muted for
several frames because the tape is being synchronized
with the REF input.
25 Hz (HD) mode: Status in which “3” (25 (HD)) has been
selected
25 Hz (SD) mode: Status in which “4” (25(SD)) has been
selected
<Notes>
•
This setting remains unchanged even when the
factory setting operation is performed.
For the steps to take to switch the system
frequency, refer to page 105.
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
*DW:This is for SD outputs (during SD tape playback or down-
conversion outputs).
•
80
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup menus
<BASIC>
No./Item
Description of setting
No./Item
004*1
Description of setting
000
For setting the preroll time.
For setting whether or not to synchronize the
phases between two decks.
Any time from 0 to 30 seconds can be set in 1-
second increments.
P-ROLL TIME
0000
OFF:
SYNCHRONIZE
The phases are not synchronized. The edit
points will be off by several frames but editing
will be commenced more promptly.
0000
0s
:
5s
:
:
0005
:
0030
<Notes>
0001
ON:
The phases are synchronized. Error-free
editing can be performed.
30s
•
During automatic editing (PREVIEW or AUTO EDIT),
no operations are performed if the preroll time is set
to 0 seconds.
If the phases are to be synchronized between two
decks for editing as per the setup menu item No.004
(SYNCHRONIZE) setting, set the preroll time to at
least 2 seconds.
005
For selecting whether or not to superimpose
the display of the time code or other data
onto the HD SDI MONITOR, SD SDI MONITOR
and VIDEO OUT3 connectors.
SUPER
•
0000
OFF:
The time code or other data is not displayed.
0001
ON:
001
For selecting the transport system buttons
which can be operated on the front panel in
the REMOTE mode.
The time code or other data is displayed.
006
For selecting the time code and other
displays to be superimposed onto the HD SDI
DISPLAY SEL MONITOR, SD SDI MONITOR and VIDEO
OUT3 connectors.
LOCAL ENA
0000
0001 ST&EJ
DIS
:
:
No buttons can be operated.
Only the STOP and EJECT buttons can be
operated.
0000
TIME:
Only the time is displayed.
0002
ENA:
0001 T&STA
The time and operation mode are displayed.
:
All the buttons except for the RECORDER and
PLAYER buttons can be operated.
<Note>
0002 T&S&M
:
The following buttons and dials function at all times
regardless of this setting:
The time, operation mode and mode are
displayed.
Audio input/output level control dials, audio channel
selector buttons, number keys, function buttons, direct
menu button, ASSEM button, INSERT button, ADJ dial,
headphone volume control dial, MONITOR SELECT
button, METER (FULL/FINE) selector switch, REMOTE
button.
0003
T&RT:
The time and REC TIME are displayed.
0004 T&YMD
The time and REC DATE (year/month/day) are
displayed.
:
0005 T&MDY
:
002*1
The time and REC DATE (month/day/year) are
displayed.
For selecting the 12- or 24-hour system for
the CTL counter display.
0006 T&DMY
The time and REC DATE (day/month/year) are
displayed.
:
d
0000
0001
12h
:
:
12-hour system display
24-hour system display
TAPE TIMER
24h
003
For selecting whether or not to display REMAIN
(remaining tape time) on the superimposed
display of the HD SDI MONITOR, SD SDI
MONITOR and VIDEO OUT3 connectors.
0007
T&UB:
Data and user’s bit are displayed.
However, when UB has been selected with the
REMAIN SEL
F3
(TC/CTL) on the HOME menu, the time
0000
OFF:
code is displayed after the user’s bit.
0008 T&CTL
Data and CTL data are displayed.
However, when CTL has been selected with
The remaining tape time is not displayed.
:
0001
2L:
The remaining tape time is displayed on the
second line.
F3
the
(TC/CTL) on the HOME menu, the time
0002
1L:
code is displayed after the CTL data.
The remaining tape time is displayed on the
first line.
0009
T&T:
Data and time code are displayed.
0003
R/TTL:
The remaining tape time is displayed on the
first line, and the total tape time is displayed on
the second line.
(See Notes on next page.)
<Notes>
•
When setting 1 (2L) has been selected, the remaining
tape time is not displayed if 0 (TIME) is selected as
the setup menu item No.006 (DISPLAY SEL) setting.
When setting 3 (R/TTL) has been selected, the
remaining tape time is not displayed if 0 (TIME) is
selected as the setup menu item No.006 (DISPLAY
SEL) setting.
•
*1: This item is not displayed when the 23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD or
SD) mode has been selected as the system menu item.
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
81
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup menus
(continued)
<BASIC>
No./Item
Description of setting
No./Item
009
Description of setting
<Notes>
•
006
For setting the display type for the
superimposed displays and for the HD SDI
The following mode displays appear depending on
the format used.
DISPLAY SEL
CHARA TYPE MONITOR, SD SDI MONITOR and VIDEO
OUT3 connectors as well as for the SETUP
MENU, etc.
<Format>
DVCPRO HD-LP
DVCPRO HD
DVCPRO50
DVCPRO
DV
<Display>
DVCPRO_HD-LP
DVCPRO_HD
DVCPRO_50
DVCPRO
>
>
>
>
>
>
0000 WHITE
:
White characters on a black
background.
0001 W/OUT
:
White characters with black
DV
DVCAM
borders
.
DVCAM
•
•
When setting
2
(T&S&M) is selected, an error
010*1
For setting whether to forcibly set the recorder to
the EE mode and output the player’s playback
signals to the monitor if the PLAYER button on the
recorder is pressed when the monitor is connected
only to the recorder during deck-to-deck editing.
message appears if a warning or error has occurred.
REC TIME and REC DATE are displayed only during
DV or DVCAM format playback. The operation mode
is displayed when the DVCPRO HD-LP, DVCPRO
HD, DVCPRO50 or DVCPRO format is used.
MONI
CONTROL
0000
MANU:
007
For setting the horizontal positions of the
characters for the time code and other
superimposed displays of the HD SDI
MONITOR, SD SDI MONITOR and VIDEO
OUT3 connectors.
The recorder is not forcibly set to the EE mode.
0001
The recorder is forcibly set to the EE mode,
and the player’s playback signals are output
AUTO:
CHARA
H-POS
.
011
For setting the preroll time in the MULTI CUE
mode.
0000
:
0
:
CU-ROLL
TIME
Any time from 0 to 15 seconds can be set in 1-
second increments.
0006
:
6
:
0000
:
0005
:
0s
:
:
0037
<Note>
37
When this menu item has been set, the displays are
output to the VIDEO OUT3 connector in the DISPLAY
SEL status even when the SUPER OFF setting is
established. However, if the menu has been exited, the
SUPER OFF or ON setting is followed.
5s
:
:
0015
15s
:
015
For selecting the save processing to be
conducted when the memory capacity, which
enables up to 99 warning messages to be
saved, has been exceeded while the error log
function is operating.
Furthermore, CHARA TYPE is output to the VIDEO
OUT3 connector as per the menu setting.
AUTO
STEP
008
For setting the vertical positions of the
characters for the time code and other
superimposed displays of the HD SDI
MONITOR, SD SDI MONITOR and VIDEO
OUT3 connectors.
CHARA
V-POS
0000
OFF:
99 messages are set as the upper limit, and any
more warning messages which subsequently
occur are not saved in the memory.
0000
:
0
:
0001
ON:
0023
:
0032
<Note>
23
:
32
99 messages are saved, and the next warning
message that has subsequently occurred is
saved as No.99. The warning messages already
saved are each shifted down by one number in
succession.
When this menu item has been set, the displays are
output to the VIDEO OUT3 connector in the DISPLAY
SEL status even when the SUPER OFF setting is
established. However, if the menu has been exited, the
SUPER OFF or ON setting is followed.
020*2
For selecting the VTR’s recording format.
0000
1080i:
The 1080i format is selected
.
SYS
FORMAT
Furthermore, CHARA TYPE is output to the VIDEO
OUT3 connector as per the menu setting.
0001
720p:
The 720p format is selected.
*1: This item is not displayed when the 23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD or
SD) mode has been selected as the system menu item No.25
(SYSTEM FREQ) setting.
*2: This item is not displayed when the 23/24 Hz, 25 Hz (HD or SD)
or 50 Hz mode has been selected as the system menu item
No.25 (SYSTEM FREQ) setting.
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
82
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup menus
(continued)
<BASIC>
Formats in which the tape is played back
No./Item
Description of setting
022:
PB
020:
SYS
023:
FORMAT Playback format
022
For selecting the format in which the tape is
to be played back.
FORMAT FORMAT SEL
PB FORMAT
0000
MANU:
HD_LP DVCPRO HD-LP(1080i)
HD_SP DVCPRO HD(1080i)
The format is determined by the setting selected for
setup menu item No.023 (FORMAT SEL).
0001
AUTO:
422
411
420p
DV
DVCPRO50(422)
DVCPRO(411)
DVCPROP(420p)
DV
The tape is played back in the format in which it was
recorded.
1080i
023
For selecting the format when “MANUAL” has
been selected as the setup menu item No.022
(PB FORMAT) setting.
If “AUTO” is selected as the setting, the format when
playback starts is selected, and when the tape is
played back, the format is automatically detected and
matched with the format of the playback tape.
FORMAT
SEL
DVCAM DVCAM
MANUAL
HD_LP DVCPRO HD-LP(720p)
HD_SP DVCPRO HD(720p)
422
411
420p
DV
DVCPRO50(422)
DVCPRO(411)
DVCPROP(420p)
DV
0000
HD-LP
:
The DVCPRO HD-LP format is
selected, and the setup menu
item No.020 (SYS FORMAT)
setting is followed.
The DVCPRO HD format is
selected, and the setup menu
item No.020 (SYS FORMAT)
setting is followed.
720p
0001
HD-SP
:
DVCAM DVCAM
DVCPRO HD-LP(1080i)/
DVCPRO HD(1080i)/
DVCPRO HD-LP(720p)/
DVCPRO HD(720p)/
DVCPRO50(422)/
DVCPRO(411)/
DVCPROP(420p)/DV/
DVCAM, automatic detection
0002
0003
0004
0005
422
411
:
:
:
The DVCPRO50 (422) format is
selected.
The DVCPRO (411) format is
selected.
The DVCPROP (420p) format
is selected.
The DV format is selected.
The DVCAM format is selected.
AUTO
--------
--------
420p
DV
:
:
0006 DVCAM
<Notes>
030*3
0000
0001
59/23
60/24
:
:
The 59.94/23.98 Hz frequency is set.
The 60/24 Hz frequency is set.
• In the EJECT mode, the format selected by the setup menu
item No.020 (SYS FORMAT) setting applies.
However, the field frequency set here is used
only when there is no input signal which
corresponds to the OUT REF setting. If there is a
corresponding input signal, the field frequency is
matched with that of the input signal.
HD
• If “AUTO” has been selected as the setup menu item No.022
FREQUENCY
(PB FORMAT) setting, the setup menu item No.023 (FORMAT
SEL) setting is used as the format when the format is not
detected (when the tape has just been inserted).
However, when “DV” or “DVCAM” has been selected, the VTR
operation will be as if “HD-LP” has been selected.
031*4
Video output reference
0000
AUTO
:
When the HD REF input signal is
supplied, it is used as the reference. If
it is not supplied but the SD REF input
signal is supplied, the SD REF signal
serves as the reference instead.
OUT REF
If neither the HD REF nor SD REF input
signal is supplied, the HD serial signal
serves as the reference.
If none of the HD REF, SD REF and
HD serial signals are supplied, the
internal sync signal serves as the
reference.
0001
INPUT
:
:
:
When the serial input signal is supplied,
it is used as the reference
.
0002 HD_REF
0003 SD_REF
<Note>
The signal which is input to the HD REF
IN connector is used as the reference.
The signal which is input to the SD REF
IN connector is used as the reference.
*3: This item is not displayed when the 50 Hz or 25 Hz (HD or SD)
mode has been selected as the system menu item No.25
(SYSTEM FREQ) setting.
*4: This item is not displayed when the 23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD or
SD) mode has been selected as the system menu item No.25
(SYSTEM FREQ) setting.
If the 1 (INPUT) setting is selected when the 25 Hz (HD)
mode has been selected as the system menu item
No.25 (SYSTEM FREQ) setting, the system will
construe this to mean that the 0 (AUTO) setting has
been selected.
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
83
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup menus
<OPERATION>
No./Item
Description of setting
No./Item
106
Description of setting
100
For selecting the direct search dial operation.
For selecting the video and audio output
statuses in the EJECT mode.
0000
DIAL:
SEARCH ENA
Direct search dial operations are performed.
EJECT EE SEL
0000
EE:
0001
KEY
:
The EE mode is always established regardless of
the setup menu item No.140 (OUTPUT) setting.
Operation does not transfer to the search
mode unless the SHTL, JOG or VAR button is
pressed.
0001 BLACK
When setup menu item No.140 (OUTPUT) is set to:
“EE” The EE mode is established
TAPE”
:
:
.
101
For selecting the maximum speed of shuttle
operations.
0000
0001
0002
<Note>
Depending on the tape format, the actual tape running
speed differs slightly from what is indicated by the
superimposed display
:
The BLACK mode is established for
the video signals, and the audio
signals are muted.
“
k9.8
k16
k32
:
:
:
k9.8 times normal speed
k16 times normal speed
k32 times normal speed
SHTL MAX
0002
When setup menu item No.140 (OUTPUT) is set to:
“EE” The EE mode is established
TAPE”
GRAY:
:
.
:
The GRAY mode is established for the
video signals, and the audio signals
are muted.
“
.
102
For setting the maximum speed of fast
forward and rewind operations.
0000
0001
0002
0003
<Note>
If 0 (EE) is selected while the 23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD or
SD) mode has been selected as the system menu item
No.25 (SYSTEM FREQ) setting, the VTR construes that
1 (BLACK) has been selected.
k16
k32
k50
k60
:
:
:
:
:
k16 times normal speed
k32 times normal speed
k50 times normal speed
k60 times normal speed
k100 times normal speed
FF. REW MAX
107*1
For selecting what signals are to be output
when the EE mode is established.
0004
<Note>
k100
0000 NORMAL
:
EE MODE SEL
The maximum speed is automatically limited to 50x for
the DVCPRO HD and DVCPRO50 format and to 32x for
the DV and DVCAM formats.
Signals delayed by an amount equivalent to the time taken
for the signals to be processed internally are output.
0001
THRU:
104
For selecting whether a warning is to be
displayed when the REF VIDEO signal has not
been connected.
The signals are not processed internally but output in their
original form with no delay.
<Note>
REF ALARM
0000
0001
OFF
ON
:
:
A warning is not displayed.
A warning is displayed by the
blinking STOP lamp.
The internal operation forcibly sets “NORMAL” when an
editing mode is selected or when SDTI is selected
during video input signal selection.
105*1
108
For setting the play startup time in 1-frame
increments.
For selecting the VTR mode which is to be set
to the EE mode when “0 (EE)” is selected as
the setup menu item No.140 (OUTPUT)
setting.
PLAY DELAY
0000
:
0
:
AUTO EE SEL
0015
15
0000
S/F/R:
The EE mode is established when the VTR is
in the STOP, FF or REW mode.
109*1
For selecting whether to engage playback framing
lock in 4-field increments or in 2-field increments.
0001
STOP:
<59/60Hz>
0000
<50Hz>
0000
CAP. LOCK
The EE mode is established when the VTR is
in the STOP mode only.
2F
4F
2F
4F
8F
0001
0001
0002
110
For selecting whether the tape is to be
automatically wound back to its beginning
when the tape-end has been detected.
AUTO REW
0000
OFF
:
The tape stops when it reaches the
tape-end.
0001
ON
:
The tape is rewound to its beginning.
111*1
For selecting whether to automatically stop the
VTR when the counter value is at the “0” position
during CTL mode FF and REW operations.
MEMORY
STOP
0000
OFF
ON
:
:
The VTR does not stop.
0001
The VTR is automatically stopped.
<Notes>
•
Either the stop or still picture (SHTL STILL or VAR
STILL) mode, whichever has been set using setup
menu item No.307 (AFTER CUE-UP), is
established when the VTR is stopped.
*1: This item is not displayed when the 23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD or
SD) mode has been selected as the system menu item No.25
(SYSTEM FREQ) setting.
•
If both the AUTO REW function and MEMORY
function have been selected at the same time, the
AUTO REW operation takes priority.
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
84
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup menus
(continued)
<OPERATION>
No./Item
Description of setting
No./Item
113*1
REC INH
Description of setting
112
For selecting what playback images are to be
output in the STANDBY OFF mode and EJECT
mode.
For selecting whether to allow or inhibit recording
on the cassette tape.
FRZ MODE
SEL
0000
OFF:
0000
DIS
:
Recording on the cassette tape is enabled when the
cassette’s accidental erasure prevention mechanism
has been set to the recording enable position.
The video output is muted.
0001 STB OFF
:
Only when the STANDBY OFF mode is
established is the image which was being
played back at that moment frozen and output.
0001
All recording on the cassette tape is inhibited.
0002 PRE
ALL:
:
0002 SOF&EJ
:
Overwriting is inhibited during normal recording.
This is the setting to activate the accidental erasure
prevention function. While CTL is detected, the
recording is inhibited, and when CTL cannot be
detected, it is executed.
When either the STANDBY OFF mode or the
EJECT mode is established, the image which
was being played back at that moment is
frozen and output.
<Notes>
0003
NORM:
•
The status when the picture is frozen is determined
by the setup menu item No.604 (FREEZE SEL)
setting.
Normal recording is inhibited.
Use this setting when it is preferable to avoid
using normal recording in all applications
except for editing.
•
In the EJECT mode, the frozen picture is output only
when 1 (BLACK) or 2 (GRAY) has been selected as
the setup menu item No.106 (EJECT EE SEL)
setting.
0004
V/CTL:
The recording of the video and CTL signals is
inhibited.
Use this setting when it is preferable to avoid editing
in all applications except for audio editing
<Note>
•
The picture freeze is forcibly released if a change has
occurred in the output format of the HD serial output
signals when operation has transferred to the EJECT
mode.
.
When the PRE, NORM or V/CTL setting has been
selected, the REC INHIBIT lamp blinks (on for approx.
0.5 sec. and then off for approx. 0.5 sec.).
Description of MEMORY STOP function
114
For selecting whether the REC INHIBIT lamp is to
blink or light when the cassette tape has been set
to the accidental erasure protection mode.
The MEMORY STOP function does
not work if this margin is less than
REC INH
LAMP
0000
LIGHT
:
:
The lamp lights.
The lamp blinks.
d2 frames.
0 point
0001 FLASH
<Note>
REW
button
FF
button
3
1
If 1 (ALL) has been selected as the setup menu item
No.113 (REC INH) setting, the REC INHIBIT lamp will
be lighted at all times regardless of the REC INH LAMP
setting.
FF
REW
4
2
button
button
115*1
For selecting whether to enable or disable the
operation of the EJECT button on the VTR’s
front panel.
EJECT SW
INH
0000
REC
:
Operation is disabled while the
VTR is in the recording mode.
Operation is enabled in all
modes.
If the FF button is pressed, the normal FF operation is performed
since there is no 0 point in the direction of this operation.
!
@
0001
OFF
:
If the REW button is pressed, the PREROLL lamp lights (as does
the SHTL lamp), the VTR prerolls the tape, and it automatically
stops when the counter value is at the 0 position.
Accidental erasure protection function
This function is used to prevent parts already recorded on a tape from being
recorded over. Accidental erasure of pre-recorded tapes is prevented by
positioning the CTL signal rec/play heads as shown in the figure below so that
whether a recording has been made can be determined by the presence or
absence of the CTL signal. When the REC/PLAY button is pressed with a pre-
recorded tape, the tape runs but the REC button lamp blinks, the beeping
alarm is sounded, and no signals are recorded.
If the REW button is pressed, the normal REW operation is
performed since there is no 0 point in the direction of this
operation.
#
$
If the FF button is pressed, the PREROLL lamp lights (as does
the SHTL lamp), the VTR prerolls the tape, and it automatically
stops when the counter value is at the 0 position.
A/C heads
(rec/play heads)
*1: This item is not displayed when the 23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD or
SD) mode has been selected as the system menu item No.25
(SYSTEM FREQ) setting.
PRE CTL
head
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
Rough sketch showing CTL head positions
85
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup menus
(continued)
<OPERATION>
No./Item
Description of setting
No./Item
140*1
Description of setting
116
For selecting whether the EJECT lamp is to remain
lighted or go off after the cassette tape has been
ejected.
For selecting the output signals.
0000
EE:
EJECT LAMP
<In the STOP mode>:
OUTPUT
0000 MODE1
The EJECT lamp remains lighted.
0001 MODE2
:
The input signals selected by setup menu items
No.600 (VIDEO IN SEL) and No.713 (CH1 IN SEL)
to No.724 (D IN SEL 78) are output.
:
The EJECT lamp goes off.
<During recording or editing>:
The input signals selected by setup menu items
No.600 (VIDEO IN SEL) and No.713 (CH1 IN SEL)
to No.724 (D IN SEL 78) are output:
118*1
For selecting whether to allow or inhibit
recording on a tape which has been written
by a format other than DVCPRO HD-LP.
SP MODE
INH
0001
TAPE:
0000
OFF:
<In the STOP mode>
The signals played back from the tape are output.
<During recording or editing>:
The simultaneous playback signals are output.
<Note>
In order to select the output signals during recording or
editing, set setup menu item No.302 (CONFI EDIT).
Recording on the cassette tape is allowed.
0001
ON:
Recording on the cassette tape is inhibited.
<Notes>
•
When 0 (OFF) has been selected, whether recording
on the cassette tape is allowed or inhibited is
determined by the setup menu item No.113 (REC
INH) setting.
141*1
For setting what is to be controlled by the
audio volume controls on the front panel.
•
The recording format is determined by the setup
menu item No.020 (SYS FORMAT) setting.
0000
REC:
VOLUME
The controls function as REC volume controls.
131
For selecting what cue point operation is to
be performed when the multi cue function has
been set to ON.
0001
PB:
The controls function as PB volume controls.
PAGE MODE
0002
AUTO:
0000
MANU:
Normally, the controls function as PB volume
controls. However, during recording or in the
EE/INPUT CHECK status, they automatically
function as REC volume controls.
Operation is confined within the selected page,
and 6 cue points can be registered.
0001
AUTO:
When the page whose cue points are being
registered becomes full, operation is
automatically transferred to the next page, and
registration is continued. A total of 60 cue
points on up to 10 pages can be registered.
142*1
For selecting the conditions under which the
AUDIO UNITY lamp on the front panel is to light.
0000
IN:
AUDIO UNITY
The lamp lights when all the audio input levels
are set to the UNITY level.
132
For selecting whether to perform the
registration operation if all the cue points
have already been registered when the multi
0001
OUT:
The lamp lights when all the audio output
levels are set to the UNITY level.
ROTA MODE
cue function has been set to ON
.
0002 IN/OUT
:
0000
OFF:
The lamp lights when all the audio input and
output levels are set to the UNITY level.
No further cue points are registered.
0001
ON:
The registration operation is continued. If “MANU”
has been selected as the setup menu item No.131
(PAGE MODE) setting, the next cue point is
registered at CUE¢1 on the page concerned; if
“AUTO” has been selected, it is registered at CUE01.
143
For setting whether the lighting of the tape
mechanism is to be set to ON or remain OFF.
CASSTT
LIGHT
0000
OFF:
The mechanism does not light even when a
cassette is inserted.
0001
ON:
133
For setting the volume of the sound heard
when the keys are touched.
The mechanism lights when a cassette is inserted.
KEY BEEP
0000
0001
0002
OFF
LOW
HIGH
144
For switching the preset registration method
for the time code.
0000 NORMAL:
TC INPUT
The time code is input starting with the left-
most digit.
134
For setting the volume of the alarm tone.
0000
0001
0002
OFF
LOW
HIGH
0001
REV:
ALARM BEEP
The time code is input from the high-order digit
but is displayed from the right-most digit.
<Note>
If the fan motor has shut down, the alarm tone is sounded
at the HIGH volume level regardless of this setting.
145
For selecting whether the LCD monitor display on
the front panel is to be turned on or off.
*1: This item is not displayed when the 23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD or
SD) mode has been selected as the system menu item No.25
(SYSTEM FREQ) setting.
FRONT LCD
0000
OFF:
The display is turned off.
0001
ON:
The display is turned on or off in synchronization
with the screen saver operation for the time code
display area.
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
86
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup menus
<INTERFACE>
No./Item
Description of setting
No./Item
209
Description of setting
200
For selecting whether to operate two or more
VTRs in synchronization.
For setting whether or not to return the ACK
code when a command is received from RS-
PARA RUN
0000
DIS
:
The VTRs are not operated in
synchronization.
The VTRs are operated in
synchronization.
RETURN ACK 232C.
0000
0001
OFF
ON
:
:
The ACK code is not returned.
The ACK code is returned.
0001
ENA
:
212
For selecting the remote control connector
for controlling the slave machine when this
VTR is to be used as the master machine for
deck-to-deck operations.
<Note>
To operate the VTRs in synchronization, set all the
VTRs to 1 (ENA). (Refer to pages 14 and 19.)
MASTER
PORT
202
For setting what ID information is to be
returned to the controller.
0001 IN/OUT
:
:
The IN/OUT connector is used.
The OUT connector is used.
0001
OUT
ID SEL
0000
OTHER
<Note>
0001 DVCPRO
This setting takes effect only when the 9P button has
been set to LOCAL (LED off).
0002
ORIG
<Notes>
• For 0 (OTHER), the ID information of VTRs other than
DVCPRO models is set.
• Select 2 (ORIG) only when the VTR is connected to a
Panasonic controller (such as the AJ-A900, an
optional accessory).
• Select 1 (DVCPRO) or 2 (ORIG) if the 23/24 Hz mode
has been selected by system menu item No.25
(SYSTEM FREQ).
204
For selecting whether the RS-232C connector
is to function.
RS232C SEL
0000
OFF
:
The RS-232C connector does
not function.
0001
ON
:
The RS-232C connector functions.
205
For setting the RS-232C data transfer speed
(baud rate).
BAUD RATE
0000
0001
0002
0003
0004
0005
300
600
1200
2400
4800
9600
206
For setting the RS-232C data length.
(Unit: bits)
DATA
LENGTH
0000
0001
7
8
207
For setting the number of RS-232C stop bits.
(Unit: bits)
STOP BIT
0000
0001
1
2
208
For setting whether the RS-232C parity bit is
to be used and, if it is used, whether even or
odd parity is to apply.
PARITY
0000
NON:
The parity bit is not used.
0001
ODD:
The parity bit is used with an odd parity.
0002
EVEN:
The parity bit is used with an even parity.
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
87
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup menus
<EDIT>
No./Item
Description of setting
No./Item
308
Description of setting
300
For selecting the operation to be performed when
an edit point has been set incorrectly (when the
OUT point comes before the IN point).
For setting the maximum speed of VAR FWD.
0000
0001
i
4.9
:
i4.9 times normal tape speed
i2 times normal tape speed
(i1.85 times normal tape
speed for formats other than
DVCPRO HD-LP)
i2
:
IN/OUT DEL
VAR FWD
MAX
0000
MANU:
Editing is not performed unless the illegal edit
point is cleared or set properly.
0002
i1
:
i1 times normal tape speed
0001
AUTO:
<Notes>
•
The edit point which had already been input is
cleared automatically.
At any setting other than 0 (i4.9), phase adjustments
cannot be conducted from the editing controller.
Depending on the format used, the actual tape
running speed differs slightly from what is indicated
by the superimposed display.
301
For selecting whether to show a negative display
(time code display area) when the IN point is
•
NEGA FLASH greater than the OUT point.
0000
OFF:
309
For setting the maximum speed of VAR REV.
A negative display is not shown.
0001
A negative display is shown.
0000
0001
j4.9
:
j4.9 times normal tape speed
j2 times normal tape speed
ON:
j
:
2
VAR REV MAX
(j1.85 times normal tape
speed for formats other than
DVCPRO HD-LP)
302
For selecting whether to perform simultaneous
playback during editing.
0000
0002
j1
:
j1 times normal tape speed
CONFI EDIT
OFF
:
Simultaneous playback is not
performed.
Simultaneous playback is
performed.
<Note>
Depending on the format used, the actual tape running
speed differs slightly from what is indicated by the
0001
ON
:
superimposed display
.
<Note>
310
For setting the maximum speed of JOG FWD.
Simultaneous playback takes effect when TAPE is
selected as the F1 key setting on the
0000
0001
i4.9
:
i4.9 times normal tape speed
i2 times normal tape speed
(i1.85 times normal tape
speed for formats other than
DVCPRO HD-LP)
OUTPUT
i2
:
JOG FWD
MAX
<HOME> menu. Refer to setup menu item No.140 as
well.
303*1
For selecting how to connect the digital audio
edit IN points.
0000
0001
0002
i1
:
i1 times normal tape speed
CUT
FADE
:
:
Cut processing
V-fade processing
AUD EDIT
IN
<Notes>
At any setting other than 0 (i4.9), phase adjustments
cannot be conducted from the editing controller which
performs these adjustments by the JOG command.
304*1
For selecting how to connect the digital audio
edit OUT points.
0000
0001
CUT
FADE
:
:
Cut processing
V-fade processing
AUD EDIT
OUT
311
For setting the maximum speed of JOG REV.
0000
0001
j
4.9
:
j
4.9 times normal tape speed
j2
:
j2 times normal tape speed
(j1.85 times normal tape
speed for formats other than
DVCPRO HD-LP)
JOG REV MAX
305
For selecting whether to register the IN points
using the PREROLL button in cases where
AUTO ENTRY the IN points have not been registered.
0000
DIS
:
The IN points are not
registered.
0002
j1
:
j1 times normal tape speed
312
For setting the postroll time.
Any time from 0 to 5 seconds can be set in 1-
second increments.
0001
ENA
:
The IN points are registered.
306*1
For selecting the deck whose the color
framing is to be adjusted during deck-to-deck
editing.
0000 PLAYER
The player’s IN and OUT points are adjusted
(using the recorder as the reference).
0001 RECORD
The recorder’s IN and OUT points are adjusted
(using the player as the reference).
POSTROLL
TM
0000
0001
0002
0003
0004
0005
0s
1s
2s
3s
4s
5s
CF ADJ SEL
:
:
307
For selecting the VTR’s mode upon
completion of the cue-up operation.
AFTER
0000
STOP:
CUE-UP
The VTR is set to the STOP mode.
0001
STILL:
*1: This item is not displayed when the 23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD or
SD) mode has been selected as the system menu item No.25
(SYSTEM FREQ) setting.
The VTR is set to the still picture (SHTL STILL)
mode.
0002 STILL2
:
The VTR is set to the still picture (VAR STILL)
mode.
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
88
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup menus
(continued)
<EDIT>
No./Item
Description of setting
No./Item
323*1
Description of setting
320*1
For setting the allocation of the channels for
the analog audio presets of a controller when
a controller without a function to control the
edit presets of the digital audio signals is
used to edit the digital audio signals of the
VTR.
As with setup menu item No.320, the VTR’s
CH4 edit presets are set to ON or OFF
following the analog audio signals specified
by the controller.
EDIT RPLCE1
EDIT RPLCE4
0000
Not set.
N-DEF
:
The VTR’s CH1 edit presets are set to ON or
OFF following the analog audio signals specified
by the controller.
0001
CH1
:
The analog CH1 edit presets are followed.
0002
CH2:
0000
N-DEF
:
The analog CH2 edit presets are followed.
Not set.
0003
CH1+2:
0001
CH1
:
The analog CH1 or CH2 edit presets are
followed.
The analog CH1 edit presets are followed.
0002
CH2:
324*1
As with setup menu item No.320, the VTR’s
CUE edit presets are set to ON or OFF
following the analog audio signals specified
by the editor or controller.
The analog CH2 edit presets are followed.
0003
The analog CH1 or CH2 edit presets are
followed.
CH1+2:
EDIT RPLCEC
0000
N-DEF
:
321*1
As with setup menu item No.320, the VTR’s
CH2 edit presets are set to ON or OFF
following the analog audio signals specified
by the controller.
Not set.
0001
CH1
:
EDIT RPLCE2
The analog CH1 edit presets are followed.
0002
The analog CH2 edit presets are followed.
CH2:
0000
N-DEF
:
Not set.
0003
CH1+2:
0001
CH1
:
The analog CH1 or CH2 edit presets are
followed.
The analog CH1 edit presets are followed.
0002
CH2:
The analog CH2 edit presets are followed
0003
CH1+2:
The analog CH1 or CH2 edit presets are
followed.
322*1
As with setup menu item No.320, the VTR’s
CH3 edit presets are set to ON or OFF
following the analog audio signals specified
by the controller.
EDIT RPLCE3
0000
N-DEF
:
Not set.
0001
CH1
:
The analog CH1 edit presets are followed.
0002
CH2:
The analog CH2 edit presets are followed
0003
CH1+2:
The analog CH1 or CH2 edit presets are
followed.
*1: This item is not displayed when the 23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD or
SD) mode has been selected as the system menu item No.25
(SYSTEM FREQ) setting.
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
89
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup menus
<TAPE PROTECT>
No./Item
Description of setting
No./Item
403
Description of setting
400
For selecting the duration of the time taken
after the VTR is left standing in the STOP or
search STILL mode (JOG, VAR or SHTL)
before the tape protection mode is
established.
For selecting the operation to be performed
when the tape protection mode is established
after the VTR has been left standing in the
STOP mode.
STILL TIMER
STOP
PROTECT
0000
0001
0002
STEP
HALF
T-REL
:
:
:
STEP FWD
Half-loading
Tension release
(Units: s = seconds, min = minutes)
0000
0001
0002
0003
0004
0005
0006
0007
0008
0.5s
5s
<Notes>
•
•
When STEP FWD is selected, the VTR is
automatically transferred to the standby OFF (half-
loading) mode after it has been left standing in the
STOP mode for a total of 30 minutes (or 1 minute in
the case of a DV or DVCAM tape).
When, after tension release has been selected and
the VTR has been transferred to the tension release
mode, the VTR has been left standing in this mode
for a total of 2 hours, it is automatically transferred to
the standby OFF (half-loading) mode. However, in
the case of a DV or DVCAM tape, the transfer to the
tension release mode is inhibited, and the VTR
operates as if STEP FWD has been selected.
10s
20s
30s
40s
50s
1min
2min
<Note>
When a DV or DVCAM tape is
used, the time is set to 10
seconds even when a setting of
2 (10s) or longer is selected.
401
For selecting the operation to be performed
when the tape protection mode is established
after the VTR has been left standing in the
STILL status in a search mode (JOG, VAR or
SHTL).
SRC
PROTECT
0000
0001
0002
STEP
HALF
T-REL
:
:
:
STEP FWD
Half-loading
Tension release
<Notes>
•
•
When STEP FWD is selected, the VTR is
automatically transferred to the standby OFF (half-
loading) mode after it has been left standing in the
STILL status for a total of 30 minutes (or 1 minute in
the case of a DV or DVCAM tape).
When, after tension release has been selected and
the VTR has been transferred to the tension release
mode, the VTR has been left standing in this mode
for a total of 2 hours, it is automatically transferred to
the standby OFF (half-loading) mode. However, in
the case of a DV or DVCAM tape, the transfer to the
tension release mode is inhibited, and the VTR
operates as if STEP FWD has been selected.
402
For selecting whether the drum is to operate
in the standby OFF (half-loading) mode.
DRUM STDBY
0000
0001
OFF
ON
:
:
The drum stops rotating.
The drum continues to rotate.
<Precaution for STILL TIMER item setting>
The cumulative total standby time passed in the same location
increases at such times when the same material is repeatedly used
as is the case when programs are transmitted, for example.
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
90
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup menus
<TIME CODE>
No./Item
Description of setting
No./Item
505*1
Description of setting
500*4
For selecting whether or not to output the
VITC signal at the positions selected by setup
menu items No.501 (VITC POS-1) and No.502
(VITC POS-2).
For selecting the regeneration signal when
REGEN has been selected as the TCG (time
code generator) mode.
VITC BLANK
TCG REGEN
0000 TC&UB
:
0000 BLANK
:
:
The VITC signal is not output.
The VITC signal is output.
Regeneration applies to both the time code
and user’s bit.
0001
THRU
<Note>
0001
TC:
Only the SD output takes effect at this setting.
Regeneration applies only to the time code only.
0002
UB:
501*4
For setting the position where the VITC signal
is to be inserted.
Regeneration applies only to the user’s bit only.
<59/60Hz>
0000
:
0006
:
0010
<Notes>
<50Hz, 25Hz (SD)>
VITC POS-1
506*1
For selecting the editing mode range when
the VTR is operating in the REGEN mode
while performing editing operations with
“AUTO” selected as the setup menu item
No.503 (TCG MODE) setting.
10L
:
16L
:
0000
:
7L
:
REGEN MODE
0004
:
11L
:
20L
0015
22L
0000
AS&IN:
Regeneration applies during assemble or
insert editing.
•
The same line as the one selected by the setup menu
item No.502 (VITC POS-2) cannot be selected.
Only the SD output takes effect at this setting.
0001 ASSEM
:
•
Regeneration applies during assemble editing.
502*4
0002
INSRT:
For setting the position where the VITC signal
is to be inserted.
Regeneration applies during insert editing.
<59/60Hz>
0000
:
0008
:
0010
<Notes>
<50Hz, 25Hz (SD)>
VITC POS-2
507*1
For selecting the time code to be used when
HD SDI or SD SDI has been selected as the
setup menu item No.600 (VIDEO IN SEL)
setting when an external time code is to be
used.
10L
:
18L
:
0000
:
7L
:
TC SOURCE
0006
:
13L
:
20L
0015
22L
[When HD SDI has been selected]
0000
INT:
•
The same line as the one selected by the setup menu
item No.501 (VITC POS-1) cannot be selected.
Only the SD output takes effect at this setting.
The time code of the internal time code
generator is used.
•
0001
EXT_L:
503*1
For setting the synchronization of the internal
time code generator.
LTC of the TIME CODE IN connector is used.
0002
The LTC information added to the serial
signals which are input to HD SDI IN is used.
0003
SLTC:
0000 REGEN
:
TCG MODE
The time code reader is synchronized with the
time code which is read from the tape.
SVITC:
0001
PRE:
The VITC information added to the serial
signals which are input to HD SDI IN is used.
Presetting is enabled at the operation panel or
by the remote controller.
0002
AUTO:
[When SD SDI has been selected]
The REGEN and PRE settings are
automatically switched in accordance with the
operation mode.
In the editing mode: REGEN is selected.
In all other modes: PRE is selected.
0000
INT:
The time code of the internal time code
generator is used.
0001
EXT_L:
LTC of the TIME CODE IN connector is used.
504*1
0002
VITC:
For setting when the internal time code
generator is to advance depending on the
operation mode.
The VITC information added to the serial
signals which are input to SD SDI IN is used.
<Note>
If the VIDEO IN SEL input selection is changed, the time
code is converted as shown below.
[HD_SDI]
INT
EXT_L
SLTC
SVITC
RUN MODE
0000
REC:
The time code generator is advanced during
recording.
[SD_SDI]
INT
EXT_L
EXT_L
VITC
0001
FREE:
↔
↔
↔
↔
The time code generator is advanced while the
power is on regardless of which operation
mode is established.
*1: This item is not displayed when the 23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD or SD) mode
has been selected as the system menu item No.25 (SYSTEM FREQ)
setting.
*2: This item is not displayed when the 23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD) mode has
been selected as the system menu item No.25 (SYSTEM FREQ) setting.
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
91
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup menus
(continued)
<TIME CODE>
No./Item
Description of setting
No./Item
513
VITC OUT
Description of setting
508*1
For setting how the user’s bit of the time code
generated by the TCG is to be used.
For selecting how to output the VITC which is
superimposed on the output video signal.
0000
000
:
0000
SBC:
BINARY GP
NOT SPECIFIED (no character set specified)
In the playback mode, the time code recorded
in the SBC area is output.
0001
001:
ISO CHARACTER (8-bit character set
complying with ISO646, ISO2022 standards)
0001
VAUX:
In the playback mode, the time code recorded
in the VAUX area is output.
<Note>
The VITC information detected by the HD serial input is
automatically recorded in the VAUX area when the video
signals are recorded
0002
0003
0004
0005
0006
0007
010
011
100
101
110
111
:
:
:
:
:
:
UNASSIGNED 1 (undefined)
UNASSIGNED 2 (undefined)
UNASSIGNED 3 (undefined)
PAGE/LINE
UNASSIGNED 4 (undefined)
UNASSIGNED 5 (undefined)
.
514
For selecting whether to superimpose the
VITC information on the HD serial output.
0000
The VITC information is not superimposed.
0001
509
For selecting whether to exercise phase
correction control over the LTC which is
PHASE CORR generated by the TCG.
HD
VITC
EMBD
OFF:
ON:
0000
OFF:
The VITC information is superimposed.
Phase correction control is not exercised.
515
For selecting whether to superimpose the
LTC information on the HD serial output.
0000
The LTC information is not superimposed.
0001
0001
ON:
Phase correction control is exercised.
HD EMBD LTC
OFF:
510*1
For selecting whether to set the CF flag of the
TCG to ON or OFF.
ON:
0000
0001
OFF
ON
:
:
The CF flag is set to OFF.
The CF flag is set to ON.
TCG CF FLAG
The LTC information ist superimposed.
516*1
For selecting the processing to align the
phase of the time code which is output from
the TIME CODE OUT connector.
Normally, the time code which is output from the
TIME CODE OUT connector is aligned with the
output video and audio. If so required by the
connection with an external component or for
some other reason, this item makes it possible to
set the mode for aligning the phase with the
input.
511*2
For selecting the drop frame or non-drop
frame mode for CTL and TCG.
TC OUT ADV
0000
DF
:
The drop frame mode is
selected.
DF MODE
0001
NDF
:
The non-drop frame mode is
selected
.
<Note>
This DF mode setting takes effect only when LOCAL is
selected or when “ENA” has been selected as the setup
menu item No.001 (LOCAL ENA) setting.
0000
OFF:
512*1
The phase alignment processing is not
conducted. The time code which is output
from the TIME CODE OUT connector is
aligned with the output video and audio.
For switching the phase of the time code,
which is output from the TIME CODE OUT
connector, in response to the external LTC
input when a setting other than “INT” has
been selected for setup menu item No.507 (TC
SOURCE). (In EE mode only)
TC OUT REF
0001
EDIT:
During playback when an editing mode has
been selected and during editing, the time
code which is output from the TIME CODE
OUT connector is aligned with the input video
and audio. In all other modes, it is aligned with
0000
V OUT
:
The phase is aligned with the
output image.
0001
TC IN
:
The phase is aligned with the
external time code input
.
the output video and audio
.
SBC (sub code data) area:
517*1
For selecting whether to latch the TCG
display and LTC output during INPUT CHECK.
This is an area on the helical track, and it is separate from the video
and audio data area. The time codes, recording dates and times
and other tape control information complying with SMPTE/EBU
standards are stored here. As with the conventional LTC (linear time
code), the time code can be read even during rewinding or fast
forwarding. It can also be read out when the tape has stopped.
VAUX (video auxiliary data) area:
0000 MOMENT
:
TCG OUT
The INPUT CHECK mode is established only
while the INPUT CHECK key is held down.
0001
LATCH:
When the INPUT CHECK key is pressed, the
INPUT CHECK mode is established; even
when it is released, the mode remains
unchanged. The selection is released when
the video output is set to a mode other than the
EE mode.
This area is to be found in the video data area on the helical track.
The additional information relating to the video data is stored here.
*1: This item is not displayed when the 23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD or SD) mode
has been selected as the system menu item No.25 (SYSTEM FREQ)
setting.
*2: This item is not displayed when the 23/24 Hz, 25 Hz (HD or SD) or 50 Hz
mode has been selected as the system menu item No.25 (SYSTEM
FREQ) setting.
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
92
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup menus
<VIDEO>
No./Item
Description of setting
No./Item
605*1
INTERPOLATE
Description of setting
600*1
For selecting the video signal which is to be input.
0000 INT SG
During field slow playback, vertical interpolation is
conducted automatically to minimize the up/down
movement of the playback pictures. However, this
setting enables the interpolation operation to be
forcibly set to OFF.
:
The internal signal selected by the VIDEO INT
SG item is generated.
VIDEO IN SEL
0001
HDSDI:
The serial video signal which has been input to the
HD SDI IN connector is selected.
0000
0001
OFF
AUTO
:
:
The interpolation is forcibly set to OFF.
During slow playback, the interpolation
is automatically set to ON.
0002
SDTI: (In 59/60 Hz mode)
The compressed IF signal which has been input to
the SDTI IN connector is selected. (This setting
does not appear when the AJ-YAC15P optional
board has not been installed.)
606
For selecting the SD SDI or MONITOR output
signal.
SD MONI O
SEL
0000
0001
MONI: : The MONITOR signal is output.
SDI
:
The same video signal as the
one output from the SD SDI
OUT1 connector is output
0002 SD SDI
:
The serial video signal which has been input to the
SD SDI IN connector is selected. (This setting does
not appear when the AJ-UC1700G optional board
has not been installed.)
<Note>
When 1 (SDI) is selected, the time code and other
information are not superimposed on the display.
601*1
620*4
For selecting the type of internal signal.
For selecting the picture frame during down-
conversion.
0000 100%CB
:
A 100% color bar signal is selected.
0001 75%CB:
A 75% color bar signal is selected.
VIDEO INT SG
0000
0001
0002 FIT_HV
0003
0004
FIT_V
FIT_H
:
:
:
:
:
Side cut mode
Letter box mode
Squeeze mode
Semi letter box 14:9
Semi letter box 13:9
DOWNCON
MODE
0002 SMPTE
:
14:9
13:9
An SMPTE color bar signal is selected.
0003
ARIB:
621*5
For selecting the picture frame during up-
conversion.
An ARIB color bar signal is selected.
0004
A multiburst signal is selected.
0005
A ramp signal is selected.
0006 BLACK
MB:
0000
0001
FIT_V
FIT_H
:
:
Side panel mode
Top and bottom cut in vertical
direction
UPCON MODE
RAMP:
0002 FIT_HV
:
Stretch mode
:
A black signal is selected.
622
For selecting the horizontal frequency band
during down-conversion and line conversion
(1080i <> 720p).
0007
PLL:
A PLL signal is selected.
D/C RESP
H
0008
EQ:
0000
WIDE
An EQ signal is selected.
0001
STD
602*1
For selecting how to process the serial input.
623
For selecting the vertical frequency band
during down-conversion and line conversion
0000 DR OFF
:
The 8 higher bits after rounding up
the 2 lowest bits are recorded.
<>
(1080i
0000
720p).
WIDE
D/C RESP
V
SDI IN MODE
0001 DR ON
:
The signal with 8 higher bits, obtained
by dynamic rounding, is recorded.
0001
STD
624*5
For selecting the horizontal frequency band
during up-conversion and line conversion.
603
For selecting whether to mute the video output
signals if LOW RF has been detected during
playback.
0000
STD
U/C RESP
H
V-MUTE SEL
0001 NARROW
0000 N MUTE
:
The signals are not muted.
(They are frozen.)
625*5
For selecting the vertical frequency band
during up-conversion and line conversion.
0001
0002 BLACK
0003 NOISE
GRAY
:
:
:
The signals are muted with gray.
The signals are muted with black.
The signals are muted with noise.
0000
STD
U/C RESP
V
0001 NARROW
604*1
For selecting the freeze mode of the still
pictures and slow playback mode.
626
For accentuating the horizontal contours
during down-conversion and line conversion
0000
FIELD
:
:
Field freeze, field slow
FREEZE SEL
<>
(1080i
0000
720p).
D/C ENH
H
0000 FRAME
Frame freeze, frame slow
0dB
0001
0002
i0.7dB
*1: This item is not displayed when the 23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD or SD) mode
has been selected as the system menu item.
*4: This item is not displayed when the 23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD) mode has
been selected as the system menu item No.25 (SYSTEM FREQ) setting.
*5: This item is not displayed when the 25 Hz (HD or SD) mode has been
selected as the system menu item No.25 (SYSTEM FREQ) setting.
i
1dB
<Note>
0003 i1. 2dB
The numbers on the superimposed
display are approximations only.
0004
0005
i1.5dB
i2dB
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
93
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup menus
(continued)
<VIDEO>
No./Item
Description of setting
No./Item
632*2
Description of setting
627
For accentuating the vertical contours during
down-conversion and line conversion
For selecting the HD output signal format
during 720p tape playback or in the 720p EE
mode. (See table below.)
<>
(1080i
0000
0001
0002
0003
0004
0005
720p).
0dB
i0.7dB
D/C ENH V
>
720p HD_
OUT
0000
0001
0002
1080i
720p
720p
i
1dB
<Note>
i1.2dB
i1.5dB
i2dB
633*2
For selecting the SD output signal format
during 720p tape playback or in the 720p EE
mode. (See table below.)
The numbers on the superimposed
display are approximations only.
>
720p SD_
OUT
628*5
<Note>
0000
0001
0002
--------
480i
480p
For accentuating the horizontal contours
during up-conversion.
There is no output in the 60 Hz
mode.
0000
0001
0002
0003
0004
0005
0dB
i0.7dB
U/C ENH H
Output connectors
i
1dB
<Note>
i1.2dB
i1.5dB
i2dB
HD SDI OUT
SD SDI OUT
VIDEO OUT
The numbers on the superimposed
display are approximations only.
0000
0001
0002
634*2
1080i (line-
480i (down-
480i (down-
converted output) converted output) converted output)
629*5
For accentuating the vertical contours during
up-conversion.
720p
(no conversion)
480i (down-
480i (down-
converted output) converted output)
0000
0001
0002
0003
0004
0005
0dB
i0.7dB
i1dB
i1.2dB
i1.5dB
i2dB
U/C ENH V
720p
(no conversion)
480p* (down- 480i (down-
converted output) converted output)
<Note>
The numbers on the superimposed
display are approximations only.
For selecting the HD output signal format
during 480p tape (DVCPRO50P) playback.
(See table below.)
>
480p HD_
OUT
630*2
For selecting the HD output signal format
during 1080i tape playback or in the 1080i EE
mode. (See table below.)
0000
0001
0002
1080i
720p
---------
>
1080i HD_
OUT
0000
0001
0002
1080i
720p
1080i
635*2
For selecting the SD output signal format
during 480p tape (DVCPRO50P) playback.
(See table below.)
>
480p SD_
OUT
631*2
For selecting the SD output signal format
during 1080i tape playback or in the 1080i EE
mode. (See table below.)
0000
0001
0002
480p
480p
480i
>
1080i SD_
OUT
0000
0001
0002
480i
--------
480p
<Note>
There is no output in the 60 Hz
mode.
Output connectors
HD SDI OUT
SD SDI OUT
VIDEO OUT
Output connectors
0000
1080i (up-
480p*
480i (down-
HD SDI OUT
SD SDI OUT
VIDEO OUT
converted output) (no conversion)
converted output)
0000
0001
0002
1080i
(no conversion)
480i (down-
converted output) converted output)
480i (down-
0001
720p (up- 480p*
480i (down-
converted output)
converted output) (no conversion)
Muted 480i (down-
720p (line-
480i (down- 480i (down-
0002
480i (down-
converted output) converted output) converted output)
converted output) converted output)
1080i
480p* (down-
480i (down-
<Note>
(no conversion)
converted output) converted output)
During SD tape playback, the VTR cannot be operated in the 60
Hz mode.
*1: This item is not displayed when the 23/24 Hz, 25 Hz (HD or SD)
or 50 Hz mode has been selected as the system menu item
No.25 (SYSTEM FREQ) setting.
*2: This item is not displayed when the 25 Hz (HD or SD) mode has
been selected as the system menu item No.25 (SYSTEM FREQ)
setting.
*
Setup menu item No.107 and INPUT CHECK do not function,
and the same signal as this signal line is output.
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
94
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup menus
(continued)
<VIDEO>
No./Item
Description of setting
No./Item
641*2
Description of setting
636*2
For selecting the HD output signal format
during 480i tape (DVCPRO50, DVCPRO, DV or
DVCAM) playback. (See table below.)
For accentuating the horizontal contours
during up-conversion of SD SDI input signals.
0000
0001
0002
0003
0004
0005
0dB
i0.7dB
i1dB
i1.2dB
i1.5dB
i2dB
>
480i HD_
I U/C ENH
H
0000
0001
0002
1080i
720p
---------
OUT
<Note>
The numbers on the superimposed
display are approximations only.
637*2
For selecting the SD output signal format
during 480i tape (DVCPRO50, DVCPRO, DV or
DVCAM) playback. (See table below.)
480i SD_
642*2
For accentuating the vertical contours during
up-conversion of SD SDI input signals.
>
0000
0001
0002
480i
480i
480p
OUT
0000
0001
0002
0003
0004
0005
0dB
i0.7dB
i1dB
I U/C ENH
V
Output connectors
<Note>
i1.2dB
i1.5dB
i2dB
The numbers on the superimposed
display are approximations only.
HD SDI OUT
SD SDI OUT
VIDEO OUT
480i
0000
1080i (up-
480i
650
0000* CMPNT*
0001 CMPST
:
:
Level adjustment mode for the
component style
Level adjustment mode for the
composite style
converted output) (no conversion)
(no conversion)
0001
720p (up- 480i
480i
(no conversion)
STYLE
converted output) (no conversion)
Muted 480p* (up-
*
The asterisk denotes the factory setting for
AJ-HD1700E.
0002
480i
converted output) (no conversion)
651*3
For selecting the rotational axis of the chroma
phase adjustment.
<Note>
During SD tape playback, the VTR cannot be operated in the 60
Hz mode.
0000
Pb-Pr
:
The axis rotates in a perfect
circle on the SDI (component
style) vectorscope.
HUE STYLE
(SD)*DW
638*1
For selecting the up-conversion picture frame
when SD SDI input signals are supplied.
0001
U-V
:
The axis rotates in a perfect
circle on the analog (composite
style) vectorscope.
0000
FIT_V
:
Side panel mode
IN U/C
MODE
0001
FIT_H: Top and bottom cut in vertical
direction
Stretch mode
653
For adjusting the Y level of the HD SDI output.
j¶
0002 FIT_HV
:
i
to 0 dB to 3 dB)
(
Y LVL (HD)*UP
0000
:
1000
:
0.0%
639*1
For selecting the horizontal frequency band
during the up-conversion of SD SDI input
signals.
<Note>
:
100.0%
:
This setting takes effect when
“CMPNT” has been selected as the
setup menu item No.650 setting.
I U/C RESP H
0000
STD
0001 NARROW
1413
141.3%
640*1
For selecting the vertical frequency band
during the up-conversion of SD SDI input
signals.
654
For adjusting the PB level of the HD SDI
output.
j¶
i
(
to 0 dB to 3 dB)
Pb LVL
(HD)*UP
I U/C RESP V
0000
STD
0000
:
1000
:
0.0%
<Note>
0001 NARROW
:
100.0%
:
This setting takes effect when
“CMPNT” has been selected as the
setup menu item No.650 setting.
*1: This item is not displayed when the 23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD or
SD) mode has been selected as the system menu item No.25
(SYSTEM FREQ) setting.
*2: This item is not displayed when the 23/24 Hz, 25 Hz (HD or SD)
or 50 Hz mode has been selected as the system menu item
No.25 (SYSTEM FREQ) setting.
*3: This item is not displayed when the 50 Hz or 25 Hz (HD or SD)
mode has been selected as the system menu item No.25
(SYSTEM FREQ) setting.
1413
141.3%
655
For adjusting the PB level of the HD SDI
output.
Pr LVL (HD)*UP
j¶
i
(
to 0 dB to 3 dB)
0000
:
1000
:
0.0%
<Note>
:
100.0%
:
This setting takes effect when
“CMPNT” has been selected as the
setup menu item No.650 setting.
*
Setup menu item No.107 and INPUT CHECK do not function,
and the same signal as this signal line is output.
1413
141.3%
656
For adjusting the black level of the HD SDI
output.
<Note>
Setup menu items No.638, 639, 640, 641 and 642 do not function
when the AJ-UC1700G optional board has not been installed.
50 j10.0%
BK LVL
(HD)*UP
<Note>
:
150
:
:
0.0%
:
This setting takes effect when
“CMPNT” has been selected as the
setup menu item No.650 setting.
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
*UP: With HD output (HD tape playback or up-converted output)
*DW: With SD output (SD tape playback or down-converted output)
250 i10.0%
95
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup menus
(continued)
<VIDEO>
No./Item
Description of setting
No./Item
664
Description of setting
658
For adjusting the Y level of the SD SDI output
and VIDEO output.
For adjusting the chroma phase of the HD SDI
output, SD SDI output and VIDEO output.
Y LVL (SD)*DW
HUE
(C PHASE*)
j¶
i
(
to 0 dB to 3 dB)
x
i
x
(Approx. j30 to 30 )
0000
:
1000
:
0.0%
0000
:
0062
:
0124
<Note>
j
31.0
:
100.0%
:
<Note>
<Note>
:
This setting takes effect when
“CMPNT” has been selected as the
setup menu item No.650 setting.
This setting takes effect when
“CMPST” has been selected as the
setup menu item No.650 setting.
0.0
:
31.0
1413
141.3%
659
For adjusting the PB level of the SD SDI
output and VIDEO output.
If 0 (50) or 3 [25 (HD)] or 4 [25 (SD)] has been selected
as the system menu item No.25 (SYSTEM FREQ)
setting:
The HD SDI output cannot be adjusted.
The SD SDI output and video output can be adjusted
j¶
i
(
to 0 dB to 3 dB)
Pb LVL
(SD)*DW
0000
:
1000
:
0.0%
•
•
<Note>
:
100.0%
:
This setting takes effect when
“CMPNT” has been selected as the
setup menu item No.650 setting.
only when an SD format tape is being created
.
665
For adjusting the setup (black*) level of the
HD SDI output, SD SDI output and VIDEO
output.
1413
141.3%
660
For adjusting the PR level of the SD SDI
output and VIDEO output.
SETUP LVL
(BK LVL*)
(j10% to i10%)
j¶
i
(
to 0 dB to 3 dB)
Pr LVL
(SD)*DW
50
:
150
:
j
10.0%
0000
:
1000
:
0.0%
<Note>
:
0.0%
:
<Note>
:
100.0%
:
This setting takes effect when
“CMPST” has been selected as the
setup menu item No.650 setting.
This setting takes effect when
“CMPNT” has been selected as the
setup menu item No.650 setting.
250
i
10.0%
1413
141.3%
670
For adjusting the brightness of the LCD
monitor on the front panel.
661
For adjusting the black level of the SD SDI
0
:
127
:
j127
output and VIDEO output.
BRIGHT
j
50
:
150
:
10.0%
BK LVL
(SD)*DW
:
0
:
<Note>
:
0.0%
:
This setting takes effect when
“CMPNT” has been selected as the
254
127
250
i
10.0% setup menu item No.650 setting.
671
For adjusting the brightness (red) of the LCD
monitor on the front panel.
662
For adjusting the video level of the HD SDI
output, SD SDI output and VIDEO output.
0
:
127
:
j127
R-BRIGHT
j¶
i
(
to 0 dB to 6 dB)
V LEVEL
:
0
:
0000
:
1000
:
0.0%
<Note>
:
100.0%
:
This setting takes effect when
“CMPST” has been selected as the
setup menu item No.650 setting.
254
127
672
For adjusting the brightness (blue) of the LCD
monitor on the front panel.
2000
200.0%
0
:
127
:
j127
B-BRIGHT
663
For adjusting the chroma level of the HD SDI
output, SD SDI output and VIDEO output.
:
0
:
j¶
i
(
to 0 dB to 3 dB)
C LEVEL
0000
:
1000
:
0.0%
254
127
<Note>
:
100.0%
:
This setting takes effect when
“CMPST” has been selected as the
setup menu item No.650 setting.
673
For adjusting the contrast of the LCD monitor
on the front panel.
1413
141.3%
0
:
127
:
j127
CONTRAST
:
0
:
* This is the name of the menu item for AJ-HD1700E.
254
127
674
For adjusting the contrast (red) of the LCD
monitor on the front panel.
0
:
127
:
j127
R-CONTRAST
:
0
:
254
127
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
*DW: With SD output (SD tape playback or down-converted
output)
96
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup menus
(continued)
<VIDEO>
No./Item
Description of setting
No./Item
688*2
Description of setting
675
For adjusting the contrast (blue) of the LCD
monitor on the front panel.
For selecting whether to record the closed
caption signals which are superimposed on
the SD input signal.
0
:
127
:
j127
B-CONTRAST
CC REC
:
0
:
0000
OFF
:
The closed caption signals are
not recorded on the tape.
0001
ON:
254
127
The closed caption signals are recorded on the
tape if they are superimposed on the SD input
signal. In this case, they are blanked, up-
converted and then recorded.
676*3
This function clips the signals below the
pedestal level for SD SDI OUT and composite
OUT Y (luminance) signals.
0000
0001
BLK CLIP
<Notes>
OFF
ON
:
:
The signals are not clipped.
The signals are clipped.
•
When SDTI has been selected as the input signal, the
closed caption data superimposed on the
compressed input signals is recorded on the tape in
its original form regardless of this menu item’s setting.
Setup menu item No.688 does not function when the
AJ-UC1700G optional board has not been installed.
680*2
For selecting ON or OFF for the closed
caption signals in the first field.
0000 BLANK
0001 THRU
•
:
:
The signals are forcibly blanked.
The signals are not blanked.
CC (F1)
BLANK*DW
695*1
For selecting ON or OFF for blanking for the
vertical blanking period of the video signals
during SD tape playback.
681*2
For selecting ON or OFF for the closed
caption signals in the second field.
0000 BLANK
0001 THRU
BLANK LINE
:
:
The signals are forcibly blanked.
The signals are not blanked.
CC (F2)
BLANK*DW
0000 BLANK
:
All the lines are forcibly blanked.
0001
THRU:
682
This selects the composite output signal in HD mode.
None of the lines are blanked.
0000
THRU: The signal is output with no
0002
MANU:
VO SETUP
(HD)*UP
(This menu is
not displayed for
AJ-HD1700E.)
setup added.
Blanking ON or OFF is selected on a line-by-
line basis.
<Note>
When 2 (MANU) is set and the
pressed, the display transfers to the submenu screen
where the ON or OFF can be set for each line. Press
0001 ADD22L
0002 ADD21L
0002 ADD20L
:
:
:
The signal is output from line
22 with a 7.5% setup added.
The signal is output from line 21
with a 7.5% setup added.
The signal is output from line 20
with a 7.5% setup added.
button is
SHIFT
the
button again to return the display from the
SHIFT
submenu screen.
683
This selects the composite output signal in SD mode.
0000
THRU
:
:
:
:
The signal is output with no
setup added.
Submenu screen <59/60 Hz>
VO SETUP
(SD)*DW
(This menu is
not displayed for
AJ-HD1700E.)
01
0000 BLANK
:
:
The lines are forcibly blanked.
The lines are not blanked
0001 ADD22L
0002 ADD21L
0002 ADD20L
The signal is output from line
22 with a 7.5% setup added.
The signal is output from line
21 with a 7.5% setup added.
The signal is output from line
20 with a 7.5% setup added.
0001
THRU
LINE 11&274
.
:
:
:
:
12
LINE 22&285
684
For selecting whether to superimpose EDH on
the serial output signals.
Submenu screen <50Hz>
00
0000 BLANK
:
:
The lines are forcibly blanked.
The lines are not blanked
EDH (SD)*DW
0000
0001
OFF
ON
:
:
EDH is not superimposed.
EDH is superimposed.
LINE 7&320
0001
THRU
:
:
:
:
685*2
For selecting the operation mode for edge
subcarrier reduction (ESR) in the playback circuit.
15
LINE 22&335
0000
0001
OFF
AUTO
:
:
ESR is forcibly set to OFF.
ESR is automatically set to ON
or OFF in accordance with the
VTR operation.
ESR MODE
(SD)*DW
*1: This item is not displayed when the 23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD or
SD) mode has been selected as the system menu item No.25
(SYSTEM FREQ) setting.
*2: This item is not displayed when the 23/24 Hz, 25 Hz (HD or SD)
or 50 Hz mode has been selected as the system menu item
No.25 (SYSTEM FREQ) setting.
*3: This item is not displayed when the 50 Hz or 25 Hz (HD or SD)
mode has been selected as the system menu item No.25
(SYSTEM FREQ) setting.
*4: This item is not displayed when the 23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD)
mode has been selected as the system menu item No.25
686*2
For selecting the cross color processing
during playback.
0000
0001
OFF
ON
:
:
The cross color is output as is.
The cross color can be reduced.
CCR MODE
(SD)*DW
687*4
For selecting whether to superimpose the VIDEO
INDEX signal on the SD SDI output signal.
0000
OFF
:
The VIDEO INDEX signal is not
superimposed on the SD SDI
output signal.
The VIDEO INDEX signal is
superimposed on the SD SDI
output signal.
SDI INDEX 0
*DW
(SYSTEM FREQ) setting
.
0001
ON
:
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
*UP: With HD output (HD tape playback or up-converted output)
*DW:
With SD output (SD tape playback or down-converted output)97
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup menus
<AUDIO>
No./Item
Description of setting
No./Item
710
Description of setting
700*1
For selecting the audio input (CH1) reference
level.
For selecting the audio monitor output (Lch)
reference level.
0000
0001
0002
4dB
0dB
j20dB
MONIL OUT
LV
0000
0001
0002
4dB
0dB
j20dB
CH1 IN LV
701*1
For selecting the audio input (CH2) reference
level.
711
For selecting the audio monitor output (Rch)
reference level.
0000
0001
0002
4dB
0dB
j20dB
MONIR OUT
LV
0000
0001
0002
4dB
0dB
j20dB
CH2 IN LV
702*1
For selecting the audio input (CH3) reference
level.
712
For selecting the audio monitor output UNITY
or VARIABLE level.
0000
0001
0002
4dB
0dB
j20dB
MONI OUT
0000
UNITY
:
The signals are output at a
fixed level.
The signal output is coupled
with the headphones volume
control.
CH3 IN LV
0001
VAR
:
703*1
For selecting the audio input (CH4) reference
level.
0000
0001
0002
713*1
For selecting the CH1 input signal.
0000 INT SG
0001
4dB
0dB
j20dB
CH4 IN LV
:
:
The internal signal is selected.
Digital input signals are
selected.
Analog input signals are
selected.
DIGI
CH1 IN SEL
704*1
For selecting the CUE input reference level.
0002
ANA
:
0000
0001
0002
0003
4dB
0dB
j20dB
j60dB
CUE IN LV
<Note>
When DIGI has been selected, whether serial or AES is
selected for the input is determined by the setting
selected for setup menu item No.721 (D IN SEL 12).
705
For selecting the audio output (CH1)
reference level.
0000
0001
0002
714*1
For selecting the CH2 input signal.
0000 INT SG
0001
CH1 OUT LV
4dB
0dB
j20dB
:
:
The internal signal is selected.
Digital input signals are
selected.
DIGI
CH2 IN SEL
0002
ANA
:
Analog input signals are
selected.
706
For selecting the audio output (CH2)
reference level.
<Note>
CH2 OUT LV
0000
0001
0002
4dB
0dB
j20dB
When DIGI has been selected, whether serial or AES is
selected for the input is determined by the setting
selected for setup menu item No.721 (D IN SEL 12).
707
For selecting the audio output (CH3)
reference level.
715*1
For selecting the CH3 input signal.
0000 INT SG
:
:
The internal signal is selected.
Digital input signals are
selected.
CH3 OUT LV
0000
0001
0002
4dB
0dB
j20dB
0001
DIGI
CH3 IN SEL
0002
ANA
:
Analog input signals are
selected.
708
For selecting the audio output (CH4)
reference level.
<Note>
CH4 OUT LV
0000
0001
0002
4dB
0dB
j20dB
When DIGI has been selected, whether serial or AES is
selected for the input is determined by the setting
selected for setup menu item No.722 (D IN SEL 34).
716*1
For selecting the CH4 input signal.
709
For selecting the CUE output reference level.
0000 INT SG
:
:
The internal signal is selected.
Digital input signals are
selected.
0000
0001
0002
4dB
0dB
j20dB
0001
DIGI
CH4 IN SEL
CUE OUT LV
0002
ANA
:
Analog input signals are
selected.
<Note>
When DIGI has been selected, whether serial or AES is
selected for the input is determined by the setting
selected for setup menu item No.722 (D IN SEL 34).
*1: This item is not displayed when the 23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD or
SD) mode has been selected as the system menu item No.25
(SYSTEM FREQ) setting.
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
98
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup menus
(continued)
<AUDIO>
No./Item
Description of setting
For selecting the CH5 input signal.
No./Item
725*1
Description of setting
717*1
For selecting the input signals to be recorded
on the audio CH1 track.
0000 INT SG
:
:
The internal signal is selected.
Digital input signals are
selected.
0001
DIGI
0000
0001
0002
0003
0004
CH1
CH2
CH3
CH4
CH1+2
:
:
:
:
:
Audio input CH1 signals
Audio input CH2 signals
Audio input CH3 signals
Audio input CH4 signals
Audio input CH1 and CH2
mixed signals
CH5 IN SEL
REC CH1
0002
ANA
:
Analog input signals are
selected.
(CH1 input)
<Note>
When DIGI has been selected, whether serial or AES is
selected for the input is determined by the setting
selected for setup menu item No.723 (D IN SEL 56).
0005
CH3+4
:
Audio input CH3 and CH4
mixed signals
726*1
For selecting the input signals to be recorded
on the audio CH2 track.
718*1
For selecting the CH6 input signal.
0000 INT SG
:
:
The internal signal is selected.
Digital input signals are
selected.
0000
0001
0002
0003
0004
CH1
CH2
CH3
CH4
CH1+2
:
:
:
:
:
Audio input CH1 signals
Audio input CH2 signals
Audio input CH3 signals
Audio input CH4 signals
Audio input CH1 and CH2
mixed signals
REC CH2
0001
DIGI
CH6 IN SEL
0002
ANA
:
Analog input signals are
selected.
(CH2 input)
<Note>
0005
CH3+4
:
Audio input CH3 and CH4
mixed signals
When DIGI has been selected, whether serial or AES is
selected for the input is determined by the setting
selected for setup menu item No.723 (D IN SEL 56).
727*1
For selecting the input signals to be recorded
on the audio CH3 track.
719*1
For selecting the CH7 input signal.
0000
0001
0002
0003
0004
CH1
CH2
CH3
CH4
CH1+2
:
:
:
:
:
Audio input CH1 signals
Audio input CH2 signals
Audio input CH3 signals
Audio input CH4 signals
Audio input CH1 and CH2
mixed signals
REC CH3
0000 INT SG
:
:
The internal signal is selected.
Digital input signals are
selected.
Analog input signals are
selected.
0001
DIGI
CH7 IN SEL
0002
ANA
:
(CH3 input)
0005
CH3+4
:
Audio input CH3 and CH4
mixed signals
<Note>
When DIGI has been selected, whether serial or AES is
selected for the input is determined by the setting
selected for setup menu item No.724 (D IN SEL 78).
728*1
For selecting the input signals to be recorded
on the audio CH4 track.
720*1
For selecting the CH8 input signal.
0000 INT SG
0001
0000
0001
0002
0003
0004
CH1
CH2
CH3
CH4
CH1+2
:
:
:
:
:
Audio input CH1 signals
Audio input CH2 signals
Audio input CH3 signals
Audio input CH4 signals
Audio input CH1 and CH2
mixed signals
REC CH4
:
:
The internal signal is selected.
Digital input signals are
selected.
Analog input signals are
selected.
DIGI
CH8 IN SEL
0002
ANA
:
(CH4 input)
0005
CH3+4
:
Audio input CH3 and CH4
mixed signals
<Note>
When DIGI has been selected, whether serial or AES is
selected for the input is determined by the setting
selected for setup menu item No.724 (D IN SEL 78).
729*1
For selecting the input signals to be recorded
on the audio CH5 track.
0000
0001
0002
0003
0004
CH5
CH6
CH7
CH8
CH5+6
:
:
:
:
:
Audio input CH5 signals
Audio input CH6 signals
Audio input CH7 signals
Audio input CH8 signals
Audio input CH5 and CH6
mixed signals
REC CH5
721*1
For selecting the CH1 and CH2 digital input
signals.
0000
0001
AES
SDI
:
:
AES/EBU
Serial
D IN SEL12
722*1
For selecting the CH3 and CH4 digital input
signals.
0005
CH7+8
:
Audio input CH7 and CH8
mixed signals
0000
0001
AES
SDI
:
:
AES/EBU
Serial
D IN SEL34
723*1
For selecting the CH5 and CH6 digital input
signals.
0000
0001
AES
SDI
:
:
AES/EBU
Serial
D IN SEL56
724*1
For selecting the CH7 and CH8 digital input
signals.
*1: This item is not displayed when the 23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD or
SD) mode has been selected as the system menu item No.25
(SYSTEM FREQ) setting.
0000
0001
AES
SDI
:
:
AES/EBU
Serial
D IN SEL78
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
99
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup menus
(continued)
<AUDIO>
No./Item
Description of setting
No./Item
734*1
PB FADE
Description of setting
730*1
For selecting the input signals to be recorded
on the audio CH6 track.
For selecting how to process the audio edit
points (IN points and OUT points) during
playback.
0000
0001
0002
0003
0004
CH5
CH6
CH7
CH8
CH5+6
:
:
:
:
:
Audio input CH5 signals
Audio input CH6 signals
Audio input CH7 signals
Audio input CH8 signals
Audio input CH5 and CH6
mixed signals
REC CH6
0000
AUTO
:
The status established during
recording is followed.
Forcibly cut
0001
0002
CUT
FADE
:
:
Forcibly faded
735
For selecting whether to superimpose the
audio data on the HD serial output.
0005
CH7+8
:
Audio input CH7 and CH8
mixed signals
HD EMBD
AUD
0000
OFF
:
The
superimposed.
The audio data is superimposed.
audio
data
is
not
731*1
For selecting the input signals to be recorded
on the audio CH7 track.
0001
ON
:
0000
0001
0002
0003
0004
CH5
CH6
CH7
CH8
CH5+6
:
:
:
:
:
Audio input CH5 signals
Audio input CH6 signals
Audio input CH7 signals
Audio input CH8 signals
Audio input CH5 and CH6
mixed signals
REC CH7
736
For selecting whether to superimpose the
audio data on the SD serial output.
SD EMBD AUD
0000
OFF
:
The
superimposed.
The audio data is superimposed.
audio
data
is
not
0001
ON
:
737
For selecting the mixed signals for the
headphone monitor (Lch and/or Rch).
0005
CH7+8
:
Audio input CH7 and CH8
mixed signals
MONI MIX
0000
OFF
:
Neither the Lch nor Rch signals
are mixed.
732*1
For selecting the input signals to be recorded
on the audio CH8 track.
0001
0002
0003
L
R
L/R
:
:
:
Only the Lch signals are mixed.
Only the Rch signals are mixed.
Both the Lch and Rch signals
are mixed.
0000
0001
0002
0003
0004
CH5
CH6
CH7
CH8
CH5+6
:
:
:
:
:
Audio input CH5 signals
Audio input CH6 signals
Audio input CH7 signals
Audio input CH8 signals
Audio input CH5 and CH6
mixed signals
REC CH8
<Notes>
•
At the OFF setting, the signals to be output to monitor
L (or monitor R) are switched to CH1, CH2, CH3 and
so on each time the “L” or “R” button is pressed. The
selected signals are displayed below the audio level
meter.
0005
CH7+8
:
Audio input CH7 and CH8
mixed signals
733*1
For selecting the input signals to be recorded
on the CUE track.
•
At the L, R or L/R setting, the signals of a multiple
number of channels can be mixed and output. When
the number key corresponding to the channel whose
signals are to be monitored is pressed while the “L”
(or “R”) button is held down, that channel is selected.
The selected channel is displayed below the audio
level meter. (Alternatively, the same steps can be
taken to de-select a channel which has already been
selected.) However, only up to 2 channels among the
CH1-CH4 channels and up to 2 channels among the
CH5 to CH8 channels can be selected.
0000
0001
0002
0003
0004
0005
0006
0007
0008
0009
CUE
CH1
CH2
CH3
CH4
CH5
CH6
CH7
CH8
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
CUE IN
REC CUE
Audio input CH1 signals
Audio input CH2 signals
Audio input CH3 signals
Audio input CH4 signals
Audio input CH5 signals
Audio input CH6 signals
Audio input CH7 signals
Audio input CH8 signals
738
For selecting the CH1 output status of the
main signal line in the search mode.
CH1+2
Audio input CH1 and CH2 mixed signals
CH1 CUE SEL
0000
OFF:
0010
CH3+4:
The CUE signal is not output.
Audio input CH3 and CH4 mixed signals
0001
ON:
0011
CH5+6:
The CUE signal is output.
Audio input CH5 and CH6 mixed signals
<Note>
0012
CH7+8:
For details on the audio output statuses, refer to “Audio
outputs in the search mode” on page 103.
Audio input CH7 and CH8 mixed signals
0013 CH1j8
:
Audio input CH1 to CH8 mixed signals
*1: This item is not displayed when the 23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD or
SD) mode has been selected as the system menu item No.25
(SYSTEM FREQ) setting.
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
100
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup menus
(continued)
<AUDIO>
No./Item
Description of setting
No./Item
745
Description of setting
739
For selecting the CH2 output status of the
main signal line in the search mode.
For selecting the CH8 output status of the
main signal line in the search mode.
CH2 CUE SEL
0000
OFF
:
CH8 CUE SEL
0000
OFF:
The CUE signal is not output.
The CUE signal is not output.
0001
ON
:
0001
ON:
The CUE signal is output.
The CUE signal is output.
<Note>
<Note>
For details on the audio output statuses, refer to “Audio
outputs in the search mode” on page 103.
For details on the audio output statuses, refer to “Audio
outputs in the search mode” on page 103.
740
For selecting the CH3 output status of the
main signal line in the search mode.
746
For selecting the monitor output.
0000
MANU:
CH3 CUE SEL
0000
OFF
:
MONI CH SEL
The signal selected by the MONITOR SELECT
button is output.
The CUE signal is not output.
0001
ON
:
0001
AUTO:
The PCM audio signal is output in the j1.0k
to i2.0k speed range; the CUE signal is
automatically output at all other speeds.
The CUE signal is output.
<Note>
For details on the audio output statuses, refer to “Audio
outputs in the search mode” on page 103.
0002
PCM:
The PCM audio signal is output in the j32k to
i32k speed range.
<Notes>
When “AUTO” is selected and a tape in any format
except DVCPRO HD-LP is played back, the PCM
741
For selecting the CH4 output status of the
main signal line in the search mode.
CH4 CUE SEL
0000
OFF:
•
The CUE signal is not output.
0001
ON:
audio signals are output in the -1.0 to +1.1 speed
k
k
The CUE signal is output.
range.
<Note>
•
This setting takes effect when the L and R MONITOR
SELECT switches on the VTR’s front panel have
selected a channel from CH1 to CH8.
For details on the audio output statuses, refer to “Audio
outputs in the search mode” on page 103.
(If they have selected CUE, the CUE signal is output
at all speeds regardless of this menu item’s setting.)
742
For selecting the CH5 output status of the
main signal line in the search mode.
747
For selecting the channel for the monitor
output to be switched to CUE.
CH5 CUE SEL
0000
OFF:
The CUE signal is not output.
MON AUTO
SEL
When a setting other than “MANU” has been
selected for setup menu item No.746 (MONI CH
SEL), the CUE signal is automatically output to
the monitor output in accordance with the
operation mode, and the monitor channel to be
switched to CUE is selected automatically.
0001
ON:
The CUE signal is output.
<Note>
For details on the audio output statuses, refer to “Audio
outputs in the search mode” on page 103.
743
For selecting the CH6 output status of the
main signal line in the search mode.
0000
The CUE signal is not output.
0001
0000
0001
0002
L/R
:
:
:
The CUE signal is output both
to the Lch and Rch.
The CUE signal is output to the
CH6 CUE SEL
OFF:
L
Lch only
.
ON:
R
The CUE signal is output to the
Rch only.
The CUE signal is output.
<Note>
For details on the audio output statuses, refer to “Audio
outputs in the search mode” on page 103.
748
For selecting whether to enable or inhibit the
operation of the MONITOR SELECT button on
MONI SEL INH the front panel.
744
For selecting the CH7 output status of the
main signal line in the search mode.
0000
0001
0002
OFF
:
:
:
The button’s operation is
enabled.
The button’s operation is
inhibited.
CH7 CUE SEL
0000
OFF:
ON
The CUE signal is not output.
0001
ON:
ON1
In the FULL display mode,
operation is prohibited; in the
FINE display mode only,
operation is enabled.
The CUE signal is output.
<Note>
For details on the audio output statuses, refer to “Audio
outputs in the search mode” on page 103.
<Note>
Whether to enable or inhibit the button’s operation can
be selected for channels whose signals have not been
mixed by the setup menu item No.737 (MONI MIX)
setting.
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
101
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup menus
(continued)
<AUDIO>
No./Item
Description of setting
No./Item
757
Description of setting
749*1
For selecting whether the playback level
adjustment controls are to function in the EE
mode when INT SG has been selected on the
<AUDIO> function menu.
For selecting the audio CH4 signal to be
superimposed onto the SD SDI output
SD SDI CH4
SL
0000
0001
0002
0003
0004
0005
0006
0007
CH1
CH2
CH3
CH4
CH5
CH6
CH7
CH8
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
The CH1 signal is output.
The CH2 signal is output.
The CH3 signal is output.
The CH4 signal is output.
The CH5 signal is output.
The CH6 signal is output.
The CH7 signal is output.
The CH8 signal is output.
AUDIO PB VR
0000
DIS
:
The INT SG output level is fixed
at the UNITY level.
0001
ENA
:
The INT SG output level can be
varied using the playback level
adjustment controls.
750
For selecting the signal to be output to analog
output CH1.
758
For selecting how to process the digital audio
output slow signals in the JOG, VAR or SHTL
mode.
0000
CH1
:
The CH1 signal is output
.
ANA CH1 SEL
JOG PROC
0001
CH5
:
The CH5 signal is output
0000
OFF:
751
For selecting the signal to be output to analog
output CH2.
The sound without having the digital audio
output slow signals processed is output even
when the STILL mode is established.
0000
CH2
:
The CH2 signal is output
.
.
ANA CH2 SEL
0001
CH6
:
The CH6 signal is output
0001
ON:
752
For selecting the signal to be output to analog
output CH3.
The sound after having the digital audio output
slow signals processed is output.
0000
0001
CH3
CH7
:
:
The CH3 signal is output
The CH7 signal is output
.
.
ANA CH3 SEL
759
For selecting the audio output level during DV
format playback.
753
For selecting the signal to be output to analog
output CH4.
DV PB ATT
0000
OFF:
The audio output level is not attenuated.
0000
0001
CH4
CH8
:
:
The CH4 signal is output
The CH8 signal is output
.
.
ANA CH4 SEL
0001
ON:
The audio output level is attenuated.
754
For selecting the audio CH1 signal to be
superimposed onto the SD SDI output.
760*1
For selecting whether to mute the sound at
the joins between recordings during DV or
DVCAM format playback.
SD SDI CH1
SL
0000
0001
0002
0003
0004
0005
0006
0007
CH1
CH2
CH3
CH4
CH5
CH6
CH7
CH8
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
The CH1 signal is output.
The CH2 signal is output.
The CH3 signal is output.
The CH4 signal is output.
The CH5 signal is output.
The CH6 signal is output.
The CH7 signal is output.
The CH8 signal is output.
REC PT MUTE
0000
OFF
:
The sound is not muted.
0001
ON
:
The sound is muted.
761*1
For selecting the type of internal signal.
0000
0001 SILNCE
TONE
:
:
A sine wave signal is selected.
A silent signal is selected.
AUDIO INT SG
762
This item enables signals to be recorded and
played back without passing them through
the rate converter in the audio input/output
section (without engaging the digital filter).
755
For selecting the audio CH2 signal to be
superimposed onto the SD SDI output
AUD RATE
CON
SD SDI CH2
SL
0000
0001
0002
0003
0004
0005
0006
0007
CH1
CH2
CH3
CH4
CH5
CH6
CH7
CH8
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
The CH1 signal is output.
The CH2 signal is output.
The CH3 signal is output.
The CH4 signal is output.
The CH5 signal is output.
The CH6 signal is output.
The CH7 signal is output.
The CH8 signal is output.
0000
OFF:
The signals are recorded and played back
without passing them through the rate
converter.
0001
ON:
The signals are recorded and played back after
passing them through the rate converter.
<Notes>
756
For selecting the audio CH3 signal to be
superimposed onto the SD SDI output
•
•
•
ON/OFF control is exercised at the same time for
both recording and playback. It cannot be set
differently for recording or playback.
SD SDI CH3
SL
0000
0001
0002
0003
0004
0005
0006
0007
CH1
CH2
CH3
CH4
CH5
CH6
CH7
CH8
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
The CH1 signal is output.
The CH2 signal is output.
The CH3 signal is output.
The CH4 signal is output.
The CH5 signal is output.
The CH6 signal is output.
The CH7 signal is output.
The CH8 signal is output.
ON/OFF control is exercised at the same time for
CH1 to CH8.
ON or OFF cannot be set
independently for each channel.
When the rate converter is set to OFF, the video input
signals and AES (EBU) input signals must be
synchronized. Moreover, the video input signals and
reference signal selected by OUT REF must also be
synchronized. (Noise may occur if these signals are
not synchronized.)
•
In the 60 Hz mode, noise may occur if OFF is set for
the rate converter.
*1: This item is not displayed when the 23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD or
SD) mode has been selected as the system menu item No.25
(SYSTEM FREQ) setting.
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
102
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup menus
(continued)
<AUDIO>
No./Item
Description of setting
No./Item
791
CUE PB VOL
Description of setting
763
For selecting the scale display of the audio
level meter.
0000 PEAK_0:
For adjusting the playback level of the CUE
audio signal.
j¶
i
(
to 0 dB to 12 dB)
METER
SCALE
[The audio level is displayed with 0 dB as the
maximum level.
0032
:
0016
:
16
:
0
(This menu is
not displayed for
AJ-HD1700E.)
0001
REF_0
:
The audio level is displayed with 0 dB as the
reference level.
:
0000
j
16
790*5
For adjusting the recording level of the CUE
audio signal.
j¶
i
(
to 0 dB to 12 dB)
CUE REC VOL
0032
:
0016
:
16
:
0
<Note>
This item is not displayed
when the 23/24 Hz mode has
been selected as the system
menu item No.25 (SYSTEM
FREQ) setting.
:
0000
j
16
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
Audio outputs in the search mode
The table below lists the signals which are output to the monitor and main signal line and which are determined by how the settings of menu
items No.738 to No.745, and No.746 and No.747 are combined.
738 CH1 CUE SEL:
746
MONI CH
SEL
747
MON AUTO
SEL
Monitor output
Main signal line output
:
Lch
Rch
CH1/CH3/CH5/CH7
CH2/CH4/CH6/CH8
745 CH8 CUE SEL
L/R
L
PC*1
PCM*1
MANU
AUTO
PCM
R
PCM*1
PCM*1
CUE*2
CUE*2
PCM*1
CUE*2
PCM*1
CUE*2
L/R
L
OFF
R
L/R
L
PCM*3
PCM*1
PCM*3
PCM*1
PCM*4
PCM*1
PCM*4
PCM*1
R
L/R
L
MANU
AUTO
PCM
R
CUE*2
CUE*2
PCM*1
CUE*2
PCM*1
CUE*2
CUE*2
CUE*2
PCM*1
CUE*2
PCM*1
CUE*2
PCM*3
PCM*4
PCM*3
L/R
L
ON
R
L/R
L
PCM*3
PCM*4
PCM*3
PCM*3
R
<Notes>
*1: The PCM audio output is muted if the tape is played back at a *3: During fast forwarding or rewinding, the CUE signal is output
speed in the j1.0k to i2.0k range (or at a speed in the j1.0k
automatically.
to i1.1k range for a format other than DVCPRO HD-LP).
*4: During fast forwarding or rewinding, this signal is muted.
*2: In the case of the CUE audio output, the PCM signals are output *5: This item is not displayed when the 23/24 Hz mode or 25 Hz (HD
if the tape is played back at a speed in thejj1.0k to i2.0k
range (or at a speed in the -1.0k to +1.1k range for a format
other than DVCPRO HD-LP).
or SD) mode has been selected as the system menu item No.25
(SYSTEM FREQ) setting.
103
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup menus
<MENU>
No./Item
Description of setting
A02
C
This VTR is equipped with VTR MEMORY
for storing the current settings (*1) and VTR
P. ON LOAD
1
4
MEMORY
MEMORY
MEMORY
MEMORY
to
for backing up VTR
C
.
The data of a selected VTR
can be loaded into VTR
and operation started on the
1
4
to
C
basis of this data when the power is turned
on.
0000
OFF:
Operation is started using the previous
settings.
0001 USER1
:
1
The VTR MEMORY
data is loaded and
operation started on the basis of this data.
0002 USER2
:
2
The VTR MEMORY
data is loaded and
operation started on the basis of this data.
0003 USER3
:
3
The VTR MEMORY
data is loaded and
*1: The term “settings” here denotes all the settings of the setup
menus, what is registered in the PF1/PF2 menus, and the
contents of some of the function buttons.
operation started on the basis of this data.
0004 USER4
:
4
The VTR MEMORY
data is loaded and
operation started on the basis of this data.
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
<Connections with Dolby-E* components>
When the VTR is to be connected to a Dolby-E encoder/decoder for recording or playing back Dolby-E data, set
the audio input and output levels to UNITY, and select the following setup menu item settings.
No.303 AUD EDIT IN = CUT
No.304 AUD EDIT OUT = CUT
No.725 REC CH1 = CH1
No.726 REC CH2 = CH2
No.727 REC CH3 = CH3
No.728 REC CH4 = CH4
No.729 REC CH5 = CH5
No.730 REC CH6 = CH6
No.731 REC CH7 = CH7
No.732 REC CH8 = CH8
No.734 PB FADE = CUT
No.758 JOG PROC = OFF
No.762 AUD RATE CON = OFF
<Notes>
• Dolby-E data cannot be recorded or played back in
the 60 Hz mode.
• Adjust the timing with the video signals to cover the
time taken by the Dolby-E component for
encoding/decoding outside the VTR.
• Set the bit depth of the Dolby-E encoder/decoder to
16 bits.
• Noise will be output from the ANALOG AUDIO OUT
connectors of the channels through which the
Dolby-E data is passing.
• The audio level meter will deflect beyond the range
of its markings for those channels through which
the Dolby-E data is passing.
• Noise will be output when a tape on which Dolby-E
data has been recorded is played back in the JOG
or VAR mode.
* Dolby and the Double D symbol Î are trademarks of
Dolby Laboratories Licensing Corporation.
104
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup menus
<How to switch the system frequency>
Follow the steps below to switch the system frequency (59/60 Hz, 50 Hz, 23/24 Hz, 25 Hz (HD) or 25 Hz(SD)).
Following the procedure for the <SETUP
MENU/SYSTEM MENU> (page 60) to change the
system menu item No.25 (SYSTEM FREQ) setting.
To cancel the setting entered in step 2, press the
1
2
4
C
F
button while holding down the
button.
The above message is cleared, and after the
changed setting has been restored to the original
system menu No.25 (SYSTEM FREQ) setting,
operation returns to the SYSTEM menu operation
screen.
F5
Press
(SET) to enter the setting, and after the
function menu shown on the time code display area
has been cleared, the following message
>
appears.
<Note>
If the system menu No.25 (SYSTEM FREQ) setting
has been changed while a cassette is inserted in the
VTR, the cassette is automatically ejected.
The same procedure as above is also followed when
the system menu No.25 (SYSTEM FREQ) setting has
been changed by loading the data from an IC card in
accordance with the <CARD> procedure (page 69).
Note that even if the change being made to the system
SHIFT
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
To make the setting entered in step 2 valid, press menu item No. 25 setting is cancelled, other system
3
ENT
F
the
button while holding down the
button.
menu items affected by the change will be updated, as
The system is restarted, and the VTR starts will the associated file names.
operating in the selected mode.
<Selecting the recording/playback format and sync signals which support the
operation mode>
No.25
SYSTEM
FREQ
Format enabling recording
Format enabling playback
1080/59.94i (HD_LP, HD_SP)
1080/60i (HD_LP, HD_SP)
720/59.94p (HD_LP, HD_SP)
720/60.00p (HD_LP, HD_SP)
480/59.94p (480p)
Sync signals
HD_REF (59.94Hz, 60Hz)
SD_REF (59.94Hz)
1080/59.94i (HD_LP)
1080/60.00i (HD_LP)
720/59.94p (HD_LP)
720/60.00p (HD_LP)
50/60
The setting selected for setup menu
item No.031 (OUT REF) applies.
480/59.94i (422, 411, DV, DVCAM)
HD_REF (50Hz)
SD_REF (50Hz)
1080/50i (HD_LP, HD_SP)
576/50i (422, 411, DV, DVCAM)
576/25p over 50i (422, 411, DV)
50
1080/50i (HD_LP)
The setting selected for setup menu
item No.031 (OUT REF) applies.
720/23.98p over 59.94p (HD_SP/HD_SP)
720/24p over 60.00p (HD_SP/HD_SP)
480/23.98p over 59.94i [2:3 mode]
23/24
None
HD_REF (47.96Hz, 48Hz)
480/23.98p over 59.94i [2:3:3:2 advance mode]
HD_REF (50Hz)
SD_REF (50Hz)
25 (HD) None
720/25p over 60p
720/25p over 60p
The setting selected for setup menu
item No.031 (OUT REF) applies.
25 (SD) None
SD_REF (50Hz)
105
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup menus
<Menu management accompanying switching the system frequency>
The system menu and setup menu have some items whose settings differ and other items with which no
selection options are displayed and whose settings are fixed (indicated by the shading in the table below),
depending on the switching of the operation mode in response to the setting selected for system menu item
No.25 (SYSTEM FREQ). (Refer to the table below.)
System menu and setup menu settings
<50P IN/OUT> 50-pin connector registration
• Each of the items whose settings differ is saved in • When the items whose settings differ have been
the VTR MEMORY (current file and one of the
backup files 1 to 4). The settings that correspond to
each operation mode will be displayed so that the
settings can be performed for each operation mode.
registered in the <50P IN/OUT> 50-pin connector
pins, the settings corresponding to the operation
modes are allocated to the IN and OUT pins on the
basis of the setting numbers. However, when the
upper limit value is exceeded, the value will be
limited to this upper limit.
What has been registered is saved, but bear in mind
that when the data is registered again, it is saved by
overwriting the existing data so that the previously
registered data will be lost.
Registration of the <PF1> and <PF2> function
buttons
• When the items whose settings differ have been
registered in the <PF1> and <PF2> function buttons,
the settings that correspond to each operation mode
will be displayed so that the settings can be performed • If items, whose selection options are not displayed
for each operation mode.
due to the operation mode, have been registered in
the <50P IN/OUT> 50-pin connector, when an
operation mode in which these options are not
displayed is selected, what has been registered is
saved but no operation is possible. Bear in mind,
however, that when the data is registered again, it is
saved by overwriting the existing data so that the
previously registered data will be lost.
• If items, whose selection options are not displayed due
to the operation mode, have been registered in the
<PF1> or <PF2> function button, when an operation
mode in which these options are not displayed is
selected, what has been registered is saved but the
function button itself will become blank and cannot be
operated. Bear in mind, however, that when the data is
registered again, it is saved by overwriting the existing
data so that the previously registered data will be lost
.
System menu
System menu No.25 (SYSTEM FREQ)
No.
Menu item
COARSE
59/60
5H to 0H to 5H
23/24
50
25 (HD)
25 (SD)
j
j
j
j
j
5H to 0H to 5H
5H to 0H to 5H
12
14
15
SYS H (HD)
j
FINE
1100 to 0 to 1100
1375 to 0 to 1375
1320 to 0 to 1320
j
j
SYS SC (SD)
VO SYS H (SD)
108 to 0 to 108
115 to 0 to 115
j
j
COARSE
FINE
5H to 0H to 5H
5H to 0H to 5H
j
j
858 to 0 to 858
864 to 0 to 864
j
j
COARSE
FINE
5H to 0H to 5H
5H to 0H to 5H
16
SD SYS D (SD)
j
j
858 to 0 to 858
864 to 0 to 864
Setup menus
System menu No.25 (SYSTEM FREQ)
No.
Menu item
59/60
23/24
2F
50
25 (HD)
2F
25 (SD)
2F
109
501
502
CAP.LOCK
2F/4F
2F/4F/8F
VITC POS-1
VITC POS-2
10L to 16L to 20L
10L to 18L to 20L
7L to 11L to 22L
7L to 13L to 22L
7L to 11L to 22L
7L to 13L to 22L
INTSG
HDSDI
SDTI
INTSG
HDSDI
SDSDI
600
VIDEO IN SEL
SDSDI
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
(Continued on next page)
106
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup menus
Setup menus
System menu No.25 (SYSTEM FREQ)
No.
Menu item
59/60
23/24
50
25 (HD)
25 (SD)
d12h
24h
002
TAPE TIMER
OFF
ON
004
SYNCHRONIZE
MANU
AUTO
Same as for
59/60
010
012
013
014
020
MONI CONTROL
REC ADJUST
DET STOP
0s to 3s to 5s
OFF
ON
j
DET ADJUST
SYS FORMAT
8f to 0f to 3s10f
1080i
720p
720p
1080i
720p
60/24
720p
60/24
59/23
60/24
Same as for
59/60
030
031
HD FREQUENCY
OUT REF
AUTO
INPUT
HD_REF
SD_REF
Same as for
59/60
HD_REF
SD_REF
S/F/R
STOP
105
107
111
AUTO EE SEL
EE MODE SEL
MEMORY STOP
NORMAL
THRU
OFF
ON
OFF
ALL
113
REC INH
PRE
ALL
ALL
ALL
NORMAL
V/CTL
REC
OFF
115
118
EJECT SW INH
SP MODE INH
OFF
ON
Same as for
59/60
OFF
LOW
HIGH
135
140
141
DET BEEP
OUTPUT
VOLUME
EE
TAPE
TAPE
PB
TAPE
PB
TAPE
PB
REC
PB
AUTO
IN
142
AUDIO UNITY
OUT
IN/OUT
OUT
OUT
OUT
CUT
FADE
303
304
306
AUD EDIT IN
AUD EDIT OUT
CF ADJ SEL
CUT
FADE
PLAYER
RECORDER
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
107
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup menus
Setup menus
System menu No.25 (SYSTEM FREQ)
No.
320
Menu item
59/60
23/24
50
25 (HD)
25 (SD)
EDIT RPLCE1
EDIT RPLCE2
EDIT RPLCE3
EDIT RPLCE4
EDIT RPLCEC
N-DEF
CH1
CH2
321
322
323
324
CH1+3
BLANK
THRU
Same as for
59/60
500
503
504
505
VITC BLANK
TCG MODE
RUN MODE
TCG REGEN
BLANK
PRE
BLANK
PRE
REGEN
PRE
AUTO
PRE
REC
FREE
Same as for
59/60
TC&UB
TC
UB
AS&IN
ASSEM
INSRT
506
507
REGEN MODE
TC SOURCE
INT
EXT_L
SLTC
SVITC
508
510
BINARY GP
000 to 111
OFF
ON
TCG CF FLAG
DF
NDF
511
512
516
DF MODE
NDF
NDF
NDF
V OUT
TC IN
TC OUT REF
TC OUT ADV
OFF
EDIT
MOMENT
LATCH
517
601
602
TCG OUT
VIDEO INT SG
SDI IN MODE
100%CB to EQ
DR OFF
DR ON
FIELD
FRAME
604
605
FREEZE SEL
Same as for
59/60
OFF
AUTO
INTERPOLATE
OFF
OFF
OFF
FIT_V
FIT_H
FIT_HV
14:9
Same as for
59/60
620
DOWNCON MODE
13:9
FIT_V
FIT_H
FIT_HV
621
624
UPCON MODE
U/C RESP H
Same as for
59/60
STD
NARROW
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
108
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup menus
Setup menus
System menu No.25 (SYSTEM FREQ)
No.
Menu item
59/60
23/24
50
25 (HD)
25 (SD)
STD
NARROW
625
U/C RESP V
Same as for
59/60
Same as for
59/60
628
629
U/C ENH H
U/C ENH V
0 dB to +1 dB to 2 dB
0 dB to +1 dB to 2 dB
1080i
720p
1080i
630
631
632
633
634
635
636
637
638
1080i # HD OUT
1080i # SD OUT
720p # HD OUT
720p # SD OUT
480p # HD OUT
480p # SD OUT
480i # HD OUT
480i # SD OUT
IN U/C MODE
480i
- - -
480p
1080i
720p
720p
- - -
480i
480p
1080i
720p
- - -
480p
480p
480i
1080i
720p
- - -
480i
480i
480p
FIT_V
FIT_H
FIT_HV
STD
NARROW
639
640
I U/C RESP H
I U/C RESP V
Same as for
59/60
STD
NARROW
641
642
I U/C ENH H
I U/C ENH V
0 dB to +1 dB to 2 dB
0 dB to +1 dB to 2 dB
Pb-Pr
U-V
651
676
680
681
682
HUE STYLE
Same as for
59/60
OFF
ON
BLK CLIP
BLANK
THRU
CC (F1) BLANK
CC (F2) BLANK
BLANK
BLANK
BLANK
BLANK
BLANK
BLANK
BLANK
THRU
THRU
ADD22
ADD21
ADD20
(525 system VO SETUP (HD)
only)
Same as for
59/60
THRU
ADD22
ADD21
ADD20
683
(525 system VO SETUP (SD)
only)
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
109
Setup menus
Setup menus
System menu No.25 (SYSTEM FREQ)
No.
Menu item
59/60
23/24
50
25 (HD)
25 (SD)
OFF
ON
686
CCR MODE
SDI INDEX O
CC REC
OFF
ON
Same as for
59/60
Same as for
59/60
687
688
OFF
ON
BLANK
THRU
695
BLANK LINE
MANU
700
701
702
703
CH1 IN LV
CH2 IN LV
CH3 IN LV
CH4 IN LV
4dB
0dB
j
20dB
4dB
0dB
704
CUE IN LV
j
20dB
j
60dB
713
714
715
716
717
718
719
720
721
722
723
724
725
726
727
728
729
730
731
732
733
CH1 IN SEL
CH2 IN SEL
CH3 IN SEL
CH4 IN SEL
CH5 IN SEL
CH6 IN SEL
CH7 IN SEL
CH8 IN SEL
D IN SEL 12
D IN SEL 34
D IN SEL 56
D IN SEL 78
REC CH1
INT SG
DIGI
ANA
AES
SDI
Same as for
59/60
REC CH2
i
CH1 to CH3
4
REC CH3
REC CH4
REC CH5
REC CH6
i
8
CH5 to CH7
REC CH7
REC CH8
j
REC CUE
CUE to CH1
8
AUTO
CUT
734
PB FADE
CUT
CUT
FADE
DIS
ENA
749
760
AUDIO PB VR
REC PT MUTE
OFF
ON
TONE
SILNCE
761
790
AUDIO INT SG
CUE REC VOL
SILNCE
SILNCE
j
16 to 0 to 16
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
110
Time code and user’s bit
Time code
Setting
REC:
RUN MD on the <TC> menu
F5
4
5
The time code is used when the time code signal
generated by the time code generator (time code
signal generator) is to be recorded on the tape, its
values are to be read by the time code reader (time
code signal reader), and the absolute position of the
tape is to be displayed in increments of hours,
minutes, seconds and frames.
The time code is written in the sub-code area (data
area) of the helical track. This enables insert editing
to be conducted independently using the time code
alone. In addition, the VTR’s playback speed can be
read from the stop mode to the slow motion playback
up to high-speed playback (approx. 50k normal
speed or approx. 100k normal speed when using a
DVCPRO tape).
The time code advances simultaneously with the
recording.
FREE:
The time code advances, like time, irrespective of
the VTR operation.
Setting
REGEN:
TCG MD on the <TC> menu
F3
The continuity of the underlying time code in place
prior to editing is maintained.
PRE:
The time code can be preset using the operation
panel controls or remote controller.
AUTO:
The time code is automatically switched to REGEN
or PRE depending on the VTR’s operation mode:
during editing, REGEN is selected; at all other
times, PRE is selected.
The time code values are indicated on the display and
superimposed display.
TCR 00 : 07 : 04 : 23
t
t
t
t
Registering the TC preset values
Display the <HOME> menu.
<TC/UB>
6
Hours Minutes Seconds Frames
•
Preset (in the preset enable status)
T
1When
among the number keys is pressed,
the TC display switches to TCG (UBG), and
the TCG value characters (all digits) are
User’s bit
highlighted.
The “user’s bit” refers to the 32-bit (8-digit) data frame
among the time code signals which has been released
to users. It enables operator numbers and other
values to be recorded.
T
2When
is pressed again, one digit is
highlighted, and the change enable status is
established.
3Input the desired value using the number
keys. The entire input value can be cleared
The alphanumerics which can be used for the user’s
bit are number 0 to 9 and letters A to F.
0
F
by pressing
4To input the letters used with the user
press the same number key (toggle by
while holding down
.
’
s bit,
7
8
F
tapping
or ) while holding down . To
move from one digit to another, turn the ADJ
dial.
ENT
5To enter the value, press the
key.
Setting the internal time code
6When the display screen has been changed
C
during the input process or if the
button
Set the VTR to the stop mode.
1
has been pressed, the change enable status
is released, and the setting is canceled.
Set
Set
TC/CTL on the <HOME> menu to TC.
F3
2
3
<CTL>
•
Reset
Press
(TC CLR).
F4
SOURCE on the <TC> menu to INT (for
F1
selecting the internal time code).
111
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Concerning the time code and user’s bit
Setting the external time code
Time code and user’s bit playback
Set the VTR to the stop mode.
Set the VTR to the stop mode.
1
1
2
Set
TC/CTL on the <HOME> menu to TC.
Set
UB.
TC:
TC/CTL on the <HOME> menu to TC or
F3
F3
2
3
If the video input has been set to HD SDI input or
INT SG, set TC SRC on the <TC> menu to
The time code is displayed.
UB:
The user’s bit is displayed.
• In the event that it has become impossible to
read the time code, it is interpolated using the
CTL signal.
F1
EXT-L, SLTC or SVITC.
If the video input has been set to SD SDI (when
the optional board has been installed), set
SRC on the <TC> menu to EXT-L or VITC.
4
TC
F1
Press the PLAY button. Playback starts, and the
time code appears on the display.
3
Cue time registration, preroll and
cue-up
(These functions work only on the HOME, PF1 and
PF2 screens.)
If
(SUPER) on the <TC SHIFT> menu is set to
F1
ON, the time code value is superimposed onto the
video signals from the VIDEO OUT3 connector.
<Notes>
• While a drop frame time code is being read, the
colon between the seconds and frames is replaced
with a period.
• Registration
SET
Register the cue time by pressing the
while holding down the
button
F
button.
• If the time code signal is missing, it is interpolated
automatically using the CTL signal.
The following appears on the display.
• Presetting
T
When the
button is pressed, the characters of
the cue time or TC/UB display are highlighted.
Turn the ADJ dial to highlight the characters of the
cue time.
The subsequent steps in the registration procedure
are the same as for TCG.
T ¢ R
00:01:04:07¢
“
”: 1st, 3rd field
¢
An asterisk ( )
appears here if the
time code signal is
missing.
“¢”: 2nd, 4th fields
• Prerolling
Press the PREROLL button to preroll the tape to
the currently registered CUE point.
In the drop frame mode, the colon
between the seconds and frames
is replaced with a period. (In the
59/60 Hz mode only)
• Cue-up
Press the PREROLL button while holding down the
F
button to cue the tape up to the currently
registered CUE point.
112
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Superimpose screen
The control signals, time code, etc. are displayed on
this screen using abbreviations.
Display position
The position of the characters superimposed on the
display can be changed using
(C HPOS) and
F3
F2
(C VPOS) on the <TC SHIFT> menu and the ADJ
dial.
TV monitor
TCR
:
:
:
22 22 22 22
TCR
:
:
:
22 22 22 22
TCR
:
:
:
22 22 22 22
Abbreviations
CTL: Control signal count value
TV monitor
TV monitor
TCR: Time code data recorded in the SBC area
TCR.: Time code data recorded in the VAUX area
UBR: User’s bit data recorded in the SBC area
UBR.: User’s bit data recorded in the VAUX area
TCG: Time code data of the time code generator
UBG: User’s bit data of the time code generator
Operation mode
The VTR’s operation mode can also be displayed
using
(DISPLY) on the <TC SHIFT> menu.
F4
<Note>
[T R], [T R.], [U R] or [U R.] is displayed when the
2
2
2
2
data has not been read correctly from the tape.
Characters displayed
The background of the characters superimposed on
TCR
:
:
:
22 22 22 22
STOP
VTR operation mode
the display screen can be changed using
TYPE) on the <TC SHIFT> menu.
(C
F5
TV monitor
TCR
:
:
:
TCR
:
:
:
22 22 22 22
22 22 22 22
TV monitor
TV monitor
<Note>
When the 23/24 Hz mode has been selected as the
system menu item No.25 (SYSTEM FREQ) setting,
the time code and other information superimposed on
the MONITOR and VIDEO OUT3 connectors are not
displayed.
113
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Selecting the audio recording channels and monitor output
Audio recording channels
Monitor output channels
When
(M MIX) on the <AUDIO SHIFT2> menu is
F6
The audio channels can be selected as shown below
using the AUDIO setup menu items.
set to L, R or L/R, the signals of a multiple number of
channels can be mixed and output.
Recording
Signals recorded
track
When the number key corresponding to the channel
whose signals are to be monitored is pressed while
the “L” (or “R”) button is held down, that channel is
selected, and its signals are displayed on the audio
level meter. (The same steps can also be taken to
de-select a channel which has already been selected.)
However, only up to 2 channels among the CH1-CH4
channels and only up to 2 channels among the CH5-
CH8 channels are selected.
CH1 input, CH2 input, CH3 input, CH4 input,
CH1+CH2 input, CH3+CH4 input
CH1
CH1 input, CH2 input, CH3 input, CH4 input,
CH1+CH2 input, CH3+CH4 input
CH2
CH1 input, CH2 input, CH3 input, CH4 input,
CH1+CH2 input, CH3+CH4 input
CH3
CH1 input, CH2 input, CH3 input, CH4 input,
CH1+CH2 input, CH3+CH4 input
CH4
(Examples: CH1 + CH3 + CH5 + CH8 can be selected
but CH1 + CH2 + CH4 cannot be selected.)
CH5 input, CH6 input, CH7 input, CH8 input,
CH5+CH6 input, CH7+CH8 input
CH5
CH5 input, CH6 input, CH7 input, CH8 input,
CH5+CH6 input, CH7+CH8 input
CH6
CH5 input, CH6 input, CH7 input, CH8 input,
CH5+CH6 input, CH7+CH8 input
MONITOR SELECT switches
CH7
CH5 input, CH6 input, CH7 input, CH8 input,
CH5+CH6 input, CH7+CH8 input
EJECT
CH8
XL/L/M-cassette
Do not insert S-cassette
without adapter
POWER OFF
ON
CH1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CUE
REMOTE
CH CONDITION
MONITOR FULL/FINE
R
9P50P
RS-232C
CUE input, CH1 input, CH2 input, CH3 input, CH4
input, CH5 input, CH6 input, CH7 input, CH8
input, CH1+CH2 input, CH3+CH4 input,
L
HEADPHONES
SHTL
REV
JOG
VAR
ADJUST
PUSH-INTER
HOME
RF1
TC
RF2
CUE
ASSEM
INSERT
VIDEO UNITY
CUE
FWD
AUDIO UNITY DIAG
MENU
STAND BY PLAYER RECORDER INPUT CHECK
CH5+CH6 input, CH7+CH8 input, CH1–CH8 input
SHIFT
F1
DEF
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SERVO
PLAY
REC INHIBIT
REC
ABC
GHI
9
EDIT
REW
AUDIO CH SELECT
CH CH CH
A
IN
A
OUT
7
JKL
8
PREVIEW/
REVIEW
PRE-
ROLL
CH
1
CH
5
CH
2
CH
6
CH
3
7
4
8
MNO PQRS
4
5
6
3
T
BS
ENT
F
AUTO
EDIT
TUV WXYZ
TRIM
SET
STOPFF
1
0
2
PUSH
LOCK
IN
OUT
C
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
FULL
FULL
Number keys
114
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Display saving function
This function is provided to extend the service life of the
LCD monitor. It starts up if none of the front panel
controls have been operated or the cassette tape has not
been run at all for about 5 minutes.
While the saving function is working, the LCD monitor
display goes blank, and the “EX” symbol appears on the
time code display area.
To release the saving function, operate a button or dial
on the front panel or issue a tape transport command
from the controller. The operation performed to release
the function will be executed after the function is
released.
115
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Rack mounting
The unit can be mounted into a 19-inch standard rack
if the optional rack-mounting adapters (AJ-MA75P)
are used. For the installation rails, it is recommended
that the rail and bracket for 18-inch length (part
number CC3061-99-0400) of Chassis Trak be used. If
an even greater clearance is to be left between the
VTR and rack when the VTR is pulled out, however, it
is recommended that the 22-inch long Chassis Trak
(part number CC-3001-99-0191) be used.
Attach the outer member brackets to the rack.
Check that the height is the same for the left and
right brackets.
2
Remove the four screws at the front used to attach
the left and right side panels.
3
4
Attach the AJ-MA75P rack-mounting adapters
using the same four screws.
(The complete slide rail and bracket unit is not
available from Panasonic.)
For further details, consult your dealer.
Attach the inner members of the slide rails. Refer
to the figure below for the positions where they are
screwed into place.
1
Positions where the right (R) inner
member is screwed into place
Rack-mounting adapters
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
Remove the four rubber feet on the bottom panel
of the VTR, and install the VTR in the rack.
After the VTR has been installed, check that it
moves smoothly along the rails.
5
EIA standard rack
Inner member (18-inch rail)
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
Inner member (22-inch rail)
Fasten to rack with the
fixing screws.
<Notes>
• The length of the screws used is subject to a
restriction.
• Use screws which are less than 2/5q (10 mm)
long.
•
Attach the inner member at the same symmetrical
positions on the left (L) side as well. Fix the
members in place using 3 screws on each side
(total: 6 screws). When using the 22-inch long slide
rails, secure the screws at 4 locations.
<CAUTIONS>
• Keep the temperature inside the rack to between
x
x
x
x
41 F and 104 F (5 C and 40 C).
• Bolt the rack securely to the floor so that it will not
topple over when the VTR is pulled out.
• The letters shown in the figure are not actually
marked on the side panels.
116
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Video head cleaning
This VTR is equipped with an auto head cleaning
function which automatically reduces the amount of
dirt on the video heads. In order to maximize the
VTR’s reliability, however, it is recommended that the
video heads be cleaned as and when appropriate.
For further details on how to actually clean the heads,
consult with one of Panasonic’s service companies or
with your dealer.
Condensation
Condensation occurs due to the same principle which
is involved when droplets of water form on a window
pane of a heated room. It occurs when the VTR or
tape is moved between places where the temperature
or humidity varies greatly or when, for instance:
• It is moved to a very humid place full of steam or a
room immediately after it has been heated up.
• It is suddenly moved from a cold location to a hot or
humid location.
If condensation has formed on or in the VTR, the
AUTO OFF lamp lights, and the cassette tape is
automatically ejected. Keep the power supplied and
simply wait until the AUTO OFF lamp goes off.
It is recommended that the video heads be cleaned
after the AUTO OFF lamp has gone off.
After moving the VTR to such a location, leave it
standing for about 10 minutes rather than switching on
its power immediately.
Maintenance
Before proceeding with maintenance, be absolutely
sure to set the power switch to OFF and take hold of
the power plug and unplug it from the power outlet.
Use a soft cloth to clean the cabinet. To remove
stubborn dirt, dilute some kitchen detergent, dip a
cloth into the solution, wring it out well, and wipe.
After having removed the dirt, take up any remaining
moisture using a dry cloth.
<Note>
Do not use alcohol, benzene, paint thinners or other
solvents. They can discolor the external parts
surfaces and remove the finish.
117
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Error messages
When a warning occurs in this VTR, the warning lamp
lights up.
∫Displaying the warning information
• A warning message is displayed whenever a
warning occurs (the warning lamp lights up). When
no warnings have been detected, “NO WARNING”
is displayed.
• When a multiple number of warnings occur, the
descriptions of each warning can be checked by
turning the ADJ dial.
When the DIAG menu is opened, a description of the
warning will appear on the front panel LCD area and
TV monitor. Also, when an abnormal operation is
detected in this VTR, the AUTO OFF lamp lights up,
and a message appears on the time code display
area.
DIAG menu
This displays the VTR information.
The VTR information includes the warning information
and hour-meter (usage time) information. The DIAG
menu appears on the front panel LCD display or on a
TV monitor when the TV monitor is connected to the
VIDEO OUT3 connector in the VTR’s connector area.
∫Displaying the DIAG menu
Press the DIAG button.
The DIAG menu screen is now displayed on the
TV monitor.
1
The warning information is displayed by pressing
2
(WARN) on the time code display area, and
F1
the hour-meter information is displayed by pressing
(HOURS) on this area.
F2
The display of the hour-meter information is
scrolled using the ADJ dial.
To exit the DIAG menu, press any other direct
menu button.
3
ADJ dial
2
EJECT
XL/L/M-cassette
Do not insert S-cassette
without adapter
POWER OFF
ON
CH1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CUE
REMOTE
CH CONDITION
MONITOR FULL/FINE
R
9P50P
RS-232C
L
HEADPHONES
SHTL
REV
JOG
VAR
ADJUST
PUSH-INTER
HOME
RF1
TC
RF2
CUE
ASSEM
INSERT
VIDEO UNITY
FWD
AUDIO UNITY DIAG
MENU
STAND BY PLAYER RECORDER INPUT CHECK
SHIFT
F1
DEF
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
SERVO
PLAY
REC INHIBIT
REC
ABC
GHI
9
EDIT
REW
AUDIO CH SELECT
CH CH CH
A
IN
A
OUT
7
JKL
8
PREVIEW/
REVIEW
PRE-
ROLL
CH
1
CH
5
CH
2
CH
6
CH
3
7
4
8
MNO PQRS
4
5
6
3
T
BS
ENT
F
AUTO
EDIT
TUV WXYZ
TRIM
SET
STOPFF
1
0
2
PUSH
LOCK
IN
OUT
C
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
REC
P8
FULL
FULL
1
118
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Error messages
If “T&S&M” has been selected as the setup menu item
No.006 (DISPLAY SEL) setting, a message appears
in the mode display area whenever a warning or error
has occurred. When a multiple number of errors have
occurred, the one with the highest priority is displayed.
∫Displaying the hour-meter information
¢
Turn the ADJ dial to move the cursor ( ), and the
description for the item where the cursor is located is
shown as a superimposed display.
No./Item
H00
Description
Priority
Higher
Display and description
Error messages (see error message table): When any
problem arises with the VTR’s operation, the AUTO OFF
lamp lights, and an error message is displayed.
Displays in 1-hour increments the time during
which power has been supplied.
OPERATION
H01
INT SG: If, when “INT SG” has been selected as the audio
Displays in 1-hour increments the amount of
time during which the drum has rotated.
F1
F1
input setting by
(VID IN) on the <VIDEO> menu or by the
<AUDIO> or <AUDIO SHIFT1> menu, and the EDIT button is
pressed, this message is displayed for the first two seconds
when editing is started. In the same way, it is displayed for the
first two seconds when recording is started.
DRUM RUN
H02
Displays in 1-hour increments the amount of time during
which the tape has been running in the FF, REW, PLAY,
SEARCH (JOG, VAR and SHTL), REC and EDIT modes (but
not in the JOG, VAR, SHTL or STILL mode).
TAPE RUN
H03
NO INPUT: If, when input signals (but not analog audio
signals) are not supplied to the input connector selected by
Displays in 1-time increments the number of
times the tape has been threaded (loaded) and
unthreaded (unloaded).
F1
(VID IN) on the <VIDEO> menu or by the <AUDIO> or
<AUDIO SHIFT1> menu, the EDIT button is pressed, this
message is displayed for the first two seconds when editing
is started. In the same way, it is displayed for the first two
seconds when recording is started.
THREADING
H04
Displays in 1-time increments the number of
front loading operations.
F LOADING
H05
Warning messages (see warning message table): When
a warning occurs in this VTR, the warning lamp lights, and a
warning message is displayed. When a multiple number of
warnings have occurred, the one with the highest priority is
displayed.
Displays in 1-hour increments the amount of
time during which the LCD monitor has lighted.
LCD ON
H11
Lower
Displays in 1-hour increments the amount of
time during which the drum has rotated.
(Can be reset.)
DRUM RUNr
H12
Displays in 1-hour increments the amount of time
during which the tape has been running in the FF,
REW, PLAY, SEARCH (JOG, VAR and SHTL),
REC and EDIT modes (but not in the JOG, VAR,
SHTL or STILL mode). (Can be reset.)
TAPE RUNr
H13
Displays in 1-time increments the number of
times the tape has been threaded (loaded) and
THREADINGr unthreaded (unloaded). (Can be reset.)
H14
Displays in 1-time increments the number of
front loading operations.
F LOADINGr
H15
(Can be reset.)
Displays in 1-hour increments the amount of
time during which the LCD monitor has lighted.
(Can be reset.)
LCD ON r
H30
Displays the number of times the power has
been turned on.
POWER ON
<Note>
The resettable table hour-meter information items will
be reset by your dealer when maintenance or other
work is performed.
119
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Error messages
Warning messages
Error messages
• Display
• Description
• Description
Display
Priority
Higher
• VTR operation and remedial action
• VTR operation and remedial action
If the rotational speed of the capstan motor is
abnormally slow, the AUTO OFF lamp lights, and the
message display blinks.
CAP ROTA
TOO SLOW
FAN STOP
This is displayed when the fan motor has stopped.
VTR: Operation continues (and a warning beep is sounded
regardless of the menu setting.)
VTR: Stops.
•
Set the POWER switch to OFF and then back to ON
again.
•
Check that no foreign matter has accumulated on the fan.
NO RF
If an abnormal tension is detected at the supply side in
the capstan mode, the AUTO OFF lamp lights, and the
message display blinks.
CAP TENSION
ERROR
This is displayed when a blank part of the tape lasting for 1
or more seconds has been detected during playback.
When all of the following conditions have been met, it will be
recognized as a blank part.
VTR: Stops.
•
Set the POWER switch to OFF and then back to ON
again.
•
•
•
When no signals are output from any of the heads
When the playback data cannot be read
When the CTL signal is not present
When condensation has been detected, the AUTO OFF
lamp lights, the message display blinks, and the VTR
transfers to the EJECT mode. After the tape has been
ejected, the drum continues to rotate in order to dry out
the condensation.
DEW
VTR: Operation continues.
•
Check the tape. An unrecorded tape may have been
inserted.
SERVO NOT LOCKED
When the condensation has cleared, the AUTO OFF
lamp goes off, the message display is cleared, and the
VTR is ready for operation again.
This is displayed when the servo is not locked for 3 or more
seconds during playback, recording or editing.
VTR: Operation continues.
•
When condensation is detected in the EJECT mode,
the drum starts rotating as soon as it is detected.
When condensation is detected while a cassette is
inserted, the drum stops rotating and starts rotating
again after the tape has been ejected.
•
Check the tape. A tape recorded using a system which
does not allow playback may have been inserted
.
•
INVALID TC MODE (in 23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD or SD)
mode)
This is displayed during playback if the time code has been
recorded in the drop frame mode. The video output is
disturbed and the audio output is muted at the time code
drop point.
VTR: EJECT
Wait with the power on.
•
If the rotational speed of the cylinder motor is
abnormally high, the AUTO OFF lamp lights, and the
message display blinks.
DRUM ROTA
TOO FAST
VTR: Operation continues.
•
Check the tape. If a tape recorded using a variable frame
rate camera is to be played back in this VTR, the time
code must be recorded in the non-drop frame mode.
VTR: Stops.
•
Set the POWER switch to OFF and then back to ON
again.
TC SEQUENCE UNMATCH (in 23/24 Hz or 25 Hz (HD or
SD) mode)
This is displayed during playback if the correlation between
the active frame information and time code is irregular. The
video output may not be uniform (the movements may not
be smooth).
If the rotational speed of the cylinder motor is
abnormally slow, the AUTO OFF lamp lights, and the
message display blinks.
DRUM ROTA
TOO SLOW
VTR: Stops.
•
Set the POWER switch to OFF and then back to ON
again.
VTR: Operation continues.
If the tape start and tape end are detected at the same
time either during or after loading, the AUTO OFF lamp
lights, and the message display blinks.
VTR: Stops.
E-FF
•
Check the tape. The active frame (first frame where the
frame video is switched) information is recorded on a
tape recorded using a variable frame rate camera. When
such a tape is played back on this VTR, the 0 frame of
the time code must be detected at the active frame
position.
•
Set the POWER switch to OFF and then back to ON
again.
If the take-up reel has turned without engaging the tape
for a specific period of time during the tape start or end
processing operation while loading is being performed
(at the half position), the AUTO OFF lamp lights, and
the message display blinks.
FRONT LOAD
ERROR
LOW RF
This is displayed when a state in which the envelope level
has dropped to less than one-third of its normal level has
been detected for 1 or more seconds or when a state in
which the CTL signal level has dropped to less than one-
sixth of its normal level has been detected for 1 or more
seconds during playback, recording or editing.
VTR: Stops.
•
Set the POWER switch to OFF and then back to ON
again.
•
The CTL signal level is not detected during DV or
DVCAM playback.
•
During recording or editing, the envelope level of only the
video simultaneous play heads is detected.
VTR: Operation continues.
Clean the video heads and A/C head.
•
HIGH ERROR RATE
This is displayed when the error rate increases and
correction or interpolation is performed for either the video
or audio signals.
VTR: Operation continues.
Lower
•
Clean the video heads.
120
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Error messages
Error messages
• Description
Display
• Description
• VTR operation and remedial action
Display
• VTR operation and remedial action
If the cassette fails to move up even after 6 seconds
have elapsed since the VTR transferred to the EJECT
mode, the AUTO OFF lamp lights, and the message
display blinks.
When the tape start or end processing operation is not
completed, the AUTO OFF lamp lights, and the
message display blinks.
FRONT LOAD
MOTOR
S-FF/REW
TIMEOVER
VTR: Stops.
<Note>
•
Set the POWER switch to OFF and then back to ON
again.
If the cassette fails to move down even after 6 seconds
have elapsed since the cassette was inserted, the VTR
transfers to the EJECT mode.
If the supply reel motor rotates at an abnormally fast
rate, the AUTO OFF lamp lights, and the message
display blinks.
VTR: Stops.
•
S REEL ROTA
TOO FAST
VTR: Stops.
•
Set the POWER switch to OFF and then back to ON
again.
Set the POWER switch to OFF and then back to ON
again.
If the unloading operation fails to be completed within 6
seconds, the AUTO OFF lamp lights, and the message
display blinks.
LOADING
MOTOR
If an abnormal torque applied to the supply reel motor
is detected or if an abnormal current flowing to the
current-sensing resistor is detected, the AUTO OFF
lamp lights, and the message display blinks.
VTR: Stops.
S REEL
TORQUE ERR
<Note>
If the loading operation fails to be completed within 6
seconds, the VTR transfers to the EJECT mode
(unloading mode).
•
Set the POWER switch to OFF and then back to ON
again.
VTR: Stops.
•
Set the POWER switch to OFF and then back to ON
again.
If the take-up reel motor rotates at an abnormally fast
rate, the AUTO OFF lamp lights, and the message
display blinks.
VTR: Stops.
•
T REEL ROTA
TOO FAST
If the take-up reel motor is running in the reverse
direction, the AUTO OFF lamp lights, and the message
display blinks.
REEL DIR
UNMATCH
Set the POWER switch to OFF and then back to ON
again.
VTR: Stops.
•
Set the POWER switch to OFF and then back to ON
again.
If an abnormal torque applied to the take-up reel motor
is detected, the AUTO OFF lamp lights, and the
message display blinks.
VTR: Stops.
•
T REEL
TORQUE ERR
If an abnormal tension at the supply side is detected in
the reel mode, the AUTO OFF lamp lights, and the
message display blinks.
REEL
TENSION
ERROR
Set the POWER switch to OFF and then back to ON
again.
VTR: Stops.
•
Set the POWER switch to OFF and then back to ON
again.
If the tape has not been wound up during unloading,
the AUTO OFF lamp lights, and the message display
blinks.
VTR: Stops.
UNLOAD
ERROR
When the servo microcomputer does not follow the
instructions of the system control microcomputer even
after 10 seconds have elapsed, the AUTO OFF lamp
lights, and the message display blinks.
SERVO COMM
ERROR
•
Set the POWER switch to OFF and then back to ON
again.
VTR: Stops.
•
Set the POWER switch to OFF and then back to ON
again.
If, after the total tape amount has been detected, the
amount of tape wound up onto the take-up reel and the
amount of tape supplied by the supply reel differ to an
abnormal extent while the tape is traveling, the AUTO
OFF lamp lights, and the message display blinks.
VTR: Stops.
WINDUP
ERROR
When there is no response from the servo
microcomputer for 1 or more seconds, the AUTO OFF
lamp lights, and the message display blinks.
VTR: Stops.
SERVO
CONTROL
ERROR
•
Set the POWER switch to OFF and then back to ON
again.
•
Set the POWER switch to OFF and then back to ON
again.
If, after the cassette has been inserted, the tape take-
up reel has not wound up the tape while the total tape
amount is not detected and while the tape is traveling,
the AUTO OFF lamp lights, and the message display
blinks.
W-UP REEL
NOT ROTA
When only the servo microcomputer was reset in an
instantaneous power failure, etc., the AUTO OFF lamp
lights, and the message display blinks.
VTR: Stops.
SERVO
ERROR
•
Set the POWER switch to OFF and then back to ON
again.
VTR: Stops.
•
Set the POWER switch to OFF and then back to ON
again.
If the error message display persists even after the
VTR has been shut down and started up again,
consult your dealer.
121
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
RS-232C interface
The VTR can be operated by commands when the
RS-232C interface is used. (Refer to the command
tables on page 125 and 126.)
Hardware specifications
External interface specifications
• Connector pin specifications
Connector: D-SUB 25-pin
∫Condition for acknowledging
commands from RS-232C interface
Setup menu item No.204 (RS232C SEL): ON
(crossover cable supported)
If
the
above
condition
is
not
met,
[ACK]+[STX]ER001[EXT] is returned to the external
component. Whether [ACK] is returned depends on
the setting which has been selected for setup menu
item No.209 (RETURN ACK).
Pin No.
Signal
Description
1
2
FG
Protective ground (frame ground)
Received data (data is sent to PC)
RXD
3
TXD
Transmitted data (data is received
from PC)
4
5
CTS
RTS
DTR
SG
Clear to send (shorted with pin 5)
Request to send (shorted with pin 4)
Data terminal ready (no processing)
Signal ground
6
7
20
DSR
Data set ready (+ voltage output after
communication enable status)
• Example of connection with controller (PC)
(Using crossover cable with D-SUB 25-pin
connectors)
PC side
(D-SUB 25-pin connector)
VTR side
FG
1
2
3
4
5
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
FG
TXD
RXD
RTS
CTS
DSR
SG
RXD
TXD
CTS
RTS
DTR
SG
6
7
DTR
20
20 DSR
(Using crossover cable with D-SUB 9-pin and D-
SUB 25-pin connectors)
PC side
(D-SUB 9-pin connector)
VTR side
RXD
TXD
DTR
SG
DSR
RTS
CTS
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
FG
RXD
TXD
CTS
RTS
DTR
SG
20 DSR
122
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
RS-232C interface
2. Send format
[controller (PC)
Software specifications (protocol)
>
VTR]
Communication parameters
1.
∫ Data format
Communication Asynchronous, full duplex
system
[STX] [command] [:]
02h
[data]
.....
[ETX]
XX XX XX 3Ah XX XX 03h
Transfer rate
Bit length
Stop bit
300, 600, 1200, 2400, 4800 or 9600 bps
7 bits or 8 bits
1 bit or 2 bits
20H<XX<7FH
(XX=ASCII code: symbols, numbers, upper-
case letters)
Parity bit
ACK code
None, odd or even
Returned or not returned
[command]:
<Note>
This is the command identifier (3 bytes).
A 3-byte identifier (ASCII code: symbols,
numbers, upper-case letters) is sent as the
command.
ACK is the code which is returned from the
VTR to the controller when data has been
successfully sent from the controller.
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
[:]
The colon is the code serving as a delimiter
between the command and data.
Any changes to the settings can be made using the
setup menu items listed below.
[data]:
Communication
Setup menu item
parameter
Data (ASCII code: symbols, numbers, upper-
case letters) can be added in the number of
bytes required.
Transfer rate
Bit length
Stop bit
No.205 BAUD RATE
No.206 DATA LENGTH
No.207 STOP BIT
∫ Outline of procedure for sending data from
controller
Parity bit
ACK code
No.208 PARITY
1The send command starts with STX (start of
text = 02h). The command is then identified
by COMMAND which follows, and the data is
added as required.
No.209 RETURN ACK
The command ends with ETX (end of text =
03h).
2When a different command is to be sent, a
response is awaited from the VTR, and then
the command is sent. (See page 124.)
3If STX is sent again before ETX is sent, the
receive data buffer inside the VTR is cleared.
A command error is returned to the
controller, and the data is newly processed
with STX which was received again at the
head.
123
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
RS-232C interface
3. Return format
4. Error code table
>
[VTR
controller (PC)]
ER001: Invalid command
• Unsupported command received
• Command execution error
ER002: Parameter error
The following responses are made to the
commands. If necessary, more than one
response is made.
ER102: VTR mode error
(front loading motor)
∫ When the communication has ended
successfully
ER103: VTR mode error (loading motor)
ER104: VTR mode error (drum, capstan system)
ER105: VTR mode error (reel system)
ER106: VTR mode error (tension system)
ER108: VTR condensation error
ER1FF: VTR system error
1. The receive completion message is returned.
[ACK]
06h
2. The execution completion message is
returned.
[STX] [command] [data]
[ETX]
03h
.....
02h
XX XX XX
XX XX
[command]:
This is the message (data) which is returned
or the execution completion message
identifier.
[data]:
This is the data to be returned. It can be
omitted.
Example:
Send command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Return message (data)
[STX] OPL [ETX] . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5
[ACK] [STX] OPL [ETX]
∫ When the communication has ended
unsuccessfully
[NACK]
15h
∫ When processing is not possible due to
incorrect data or problem with the VTR
1. The receive completion message is returned.
[ACK]
06h
2. An error code is returned.
[STX] [E R N1 N2 N3 ] [E TX]
02h
Error code
03h
124
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
RS-232C interface
5. Command table
VTR
operation
Return (completion)
message
Send command
∫ Commands relating to operation control
SHTL
[STX] OSF:data [ETX]
[STX] OSF [ETX]
45
FORWARD
<Notes>
This is the forward direction shuttle command.
data = n: speed data
• As the return (completion) message, [ACK] is
returned when data is received, and only the
execution message which is subsequently
returned is listed in the table.
0: STILL
1:
2:
3:
4:
5:
6:
0.03
0.1
0.2
0.5
1
k
k
k
k
k
k
• If a command not listed in the table is received,
ER001 (invalid command) is returned after
[ACK].
2.0
(1.85 for formats other than
k
DVCPROHD-LP)
7:
8:
9:
A:
4.9
k
VTR
operation
Return (completion)
message
9.8
k
Send command
[STX] OSP [ETX]
16
k
32
k
STOP
[STX] OSP [ETX]
45
<Note>
The 16 and 32 speeds differ according to the
setting selected for setup menu item No.101
(SHTL MAX).
k
k
This command is for stopping the tape transport.
The resulting output picture and sound statuses
differ according to the setting selected for the
setup menu item No.105 (AUTO EE SEL).
For details, refer to the setup menus.
SHTL
REVERSE
[STX] OSR:data [ETX]
[STX] OSR [ETX]
45
This is the reverse direction shuttle command.
data = n: speed data
EJECT
[STX] OEJ [ETX]
[STX] OEJ [ETX]
45
0: STILL
This command is for ejecting the cassette tape.
The resulting output picture and sound statuses
differ according to the setting selected for the
setup menu item No.105 (AUTO EE SEL).
For details, refer to the setup menus.
1:
2:
3:
4:
5:
6:
0.03
0.1
0.2
0.5
1
k
k
k
k
k
k
PLAY
[STX] OPL [ETX]
[STX] OPL [ETX]
45
2.0
(1.85 for formats other than
k
This command is for starting playback.
DVCPROHD-LP)
7:
8:
9:
A:
4.9
k
REWIND
[STX] ORW [ETX]
[STX] ORW [ETX]
45
9.8
k
16
k
This command is for rewinding the tape. The
resulting output picture and sound statuses differ
according to the setting selected for the setup
menu item No.105 (AUTO EE SEL).
The maximum speed differs according to the
setting selected for the setup menu item No.102
(FF. REW MAX).
32
k
<Note>
The 16 and 32 speeds differ according to the
k
k
setting selected for setup menu item No.101
(SHTL MAX).
STANDBY
OFF
[STX] OBF [ETX]
[STX] OBF [ETX]
45
For details, refer to the setup menus.
This command is for setting the VTR to standby
OFF.
FAST
FORWARD
[STX] OFF [ETX]
[STX] OFF [ETX]
45
This command is for fast forwarding the tape.
The resulting output picture and sound statuses
differ according to the setting selected for the
setup menu item No.105 (AUTO EE SEL).
The maximum speed differs according to the
setting selected for the setup menu item No.102
(FF. REW MAX).
STANDBY ON
[STX] OBN [ETX]
[STX] OBN [ETX]
45
This command is for setting the VTR to standby
ON.
For details, refer to the setup menus.
REC
[STX] ORC [ETX]
[STX] ORC [ETX]
45
This command is for starting recording.
125
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
RS-232C interface
∫ Commands relating to inquiries
<Notes>
• In terms of the return (completion) message,
[ACK] is returned when data is received, and
only the execution message which is
subsequently returned is listed in the table.
• In the case of commands not listed in the table
below, ER001 (invalid command) is returned
after [ACK].
VTR
operation
Return (completion)
message
Send command
[STX] QCD [ETX]
CTL/TC DATA
REQUEST
[STX] CD data [ETX]
45
This command is for inquiring about the counter
value.
data = f w gh mm ss ff
f
w
=
=
F
S
gh =
With CTL:
g
=
SP(20h): for a plus display
(2Dh): for a minus display
j
h
=
0 to 9:
hours
With TC:
gh = 00 to 23: hours
mm = 00 to 59: minutes
ss = 00 to 59: seconds
(525i system)
ff
=
00 to 29: frames
<Note>
CTL or TC is returned, whichever corresponds to
the front display mode.
STATUS
REQUEST
[STX] QOP [ETX]
[STX]
[ETX]
222
45
This command is for inquiring about the VTR’s
operation mode.
= OEJ: EJECT
222
OFF: FAST FORWARD
OPL: PLAY
ORC: REC
ORW: REWIND
OSP: STOP (including STANDBY ON)
SRS: (IN/OUT) PREROLL
OBF: STAND BY OFF
OSF: SHTL FORWARD
OSR: SHTL REVERSE
OJG: JOG FORWARD/REVERSE
OSW: VAR FORWARD/REVERSE
EAE: AUTO EDIT
EON: EDIT ON (MANUAL EDIT)
EPV: PREVIEW
ERV: REVIEW
ID (VTR No.)
REQUEST
[STX] QID [ETX]
[STX] data [ETX]
45
This command is for inquiring about the VTR
used.
data = AJ-HD1700
126
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
RS-232C interface
∫ Microsoft QuickBASIC sample program
CLS
STX$ = CHR$(&H2): ETX$ = CHR$ (&H3): NAK$ = CHR$(15): ACK$ = CHR$(&H6)
PRINT "*** RS-232C COMMUNICATION SAMPLE PROGRAM ***"
PRINT "Type Command 'QUIT' to quit."
PRINT
REM *** Communication Port Initial & Open ***
REM Port 1,9600Bps,No parity,8 bit data,1 stop bit
OPEN "COM1:9600,N,8,1" FOR RANDOM AS #1 LEN = 256
REM *** Input Command & Send Command ***
SendCmd:
INPUT "Input Command ="; SEND$
IF SEND$ = "QUIT" THEN GOTO ProgEnd
PRINT #1, STX$ + SEND$ + ETX$
REM *** Wait for Receive Command ***
WHILE LOC(1) = 0
WAITKEY$ = INKEY$
IF WAITKEY$ = "Q" THEN PRINT "*** Quit ***": GOTO ProgEnd
WEND
REM *** Receive Command ***
RecvCmd:
RECV$ = INPUT$(1, #1)
IF RECV$ = STX$ THEN RECV$ = "[Stx]"
IF RECV$ = ACK$ THEN RECV$ = "[Ack]"
IF RECV$ = NAK$ THEN RECV$ = "[Nak]"
IF RECV$ = ETX$ THEN BUFFER$ = BUFFER$ + "[Etx]": GOTO DispOut
BUFFER$ = BUFFER$ + RECV$
GOTO RecvCmd
REM *** Output Receive Command ***
DispOut:
PRINT "Receive Command ="; BUFFER$
PRINT
BUFFER$ = ""
GOTO SendCmd
REM *** End Program ***
ProgEnd:
CLOSE
END
Microsoft QuickBASIC is a trademark of Microsoft Corporation.
127
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connector signals
VIDEO IN
AUDIO OUT
HD SERIAL IN
(DIGITAL)
AUDIO OUT
(DIGITAL)
BNC 1, active-through (BNC 1)
BNC 4 (CH1/CH2, CH3/CH4, CH5/CH6,
CH7/CH8), AES/EBU format
k
k
k
HD REF IN
BNC
switch provided
2, loop-through, 75™ termination
k
AUDIO OUT
(ANALOG)
XLR 4 (CH1, CH2, CH3, CH4)
k
SD REF IN
BNC 2, loop-through, 75™ termination
k
HD SERIAL OUT
(DIGITAL)
BNC
BNC
XLR
XLR
4
2
k
k
k
k
switch provided
SD SERIAL IN
(DIGITAL)
BNC 1, active-through (BNC
1) (board,
k
k
SD SERIAL OUT
(DIGITAL)
option)
SDTI IN
BNC k 1 (board, option)
CUE OUT
1
TIME CODE OUT
MONITOR OUT
1
VIDEO OUT
XLR 2 (L, R)
k
HD SERIAL OUT
(DIGITAL)
BNC
BNC
BNC
BNC
BNC
4
2
3
1
1
k
k
k
k
k
HEADPHONES
(front)
1/4-inch (6.5 mm)
SD SERIAL OUT
(DIGITAL)
VIDEO OUT
HD REF OUT
SD REF OUT
SDTI OUT
RS-422A REMOTE (9P)
REMOTE IN/OUT
O
Pin No.
Signal
BNC 1 (board, option)
k
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
FRAME GROUND
TRANSMIT A
RECEIVE B
AUDIO IN
RECEIVE COMMON
====
AUDIO IN
(DIGITAL)
BNC
4 (CH1/CH2, CH3/CH4, CH5/CH6,
k
CH7/CH8), AES/EBU format
TRANSMIT COMMON
TRANSMIT B
AUDIO IN
(ANALOG)
XLR 4 (CH1, CH2, CH3, CH4)
k
RECEIVE A
HD SERIAL IN
(DIGITAL)
BNC 1, active-through (BNC 1)
k
k
FRAME GROUND
SD SERIAL IN
(DIGITAL)
BNC
option)
1, active-through (BNC
1) (board,
k
k
REMOTE OUT
O
CUE IN
XLR
1
k
Pin No.
Signal
TIME CODE IN
XLR
1
k
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
FRAME GROUND
RECEIVE A
TRANSMIT B
TRANSMIT COMMON
====
RECEIVE COMMON
RECEIVE B
TRANSMIT A
FRAME GROUND
128
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connector signals
PARALLEL REMOTE (50P)
ENCODER REMOTE(15P)
Refer to 50P IN/OUT ASSIGN on the function menu
(page 75) for the connection pin signals.
Pin No.
Signal
1
4
7
FRAME GROUND
REM (G)
RS-232C
(D-SUB 25-pin, crossover cable supported)
REM RX (X)
REMOTE CONTROL PROTOCOL RECEIVE
8
REM TX (X)
REMOTE CONTROL PROTOCOL TRANSMIT
Pin No.
Signal
Description
1
2
FG
Protective ground (frame ground)
Received data (data is sent to PC)
14
15
REM RX (Y)
REMOTE CONTROL PROTOCOL RECEIVE
RXD
REM TX (Y)
REMOTE CONTROL PROTOCOL TRANSMIT
3
TXD
Transmitted data (data is received
from PC)
4
5
CTS
RTS
DTR
SG
Clear to send (shorted with pin 5)
Request to send (shorted with pin 4)
Data terminal ready (no processing)
Signal ground
6
7
20
DSR
Data set ready (+ voltage output after
communication enable status)
Printed circuit boards
F1 board (ADDA)
H3 board (CUE)
Switch No.
SW1
What is set
Switch No.
What is set
AUDIO INPUT IMPEDANCE SW
SW101
CUE INPUT IMPEDANCE SW
This sets the CH1 audio input impedance.
This sets the CUE input impedance.
HIGH/600™
HIGH/600™
SW101
SW201
SW301
AUDIO INPUT IMPEDANCE SW
This sets the CH2 audio input impedance.
HIGH/600™
AUDIO INPUT IMPEDANCE SW
This sets the CH3 audio input impedance.
CAUTION:
HIGH/600™
These servicing instructions are for use by
qualified service personnel only. To reduce the
risk of fire or electric shock do not perform any
servicing other than that contained in the
operating instructions unless you are qualified
to do so.
AUDIO INPUT IMPEDANCE SW
This sets the CH4 audio input impedance.
HIGH/600™
The underlining (__) denotes the factory setting mode.
129
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Specifications
[GENERAL]
Loading time:
Approx. 4 sec.
Audio split editing:
Provided
Power supply: AC 100–240V, 50–60 Hz (AJ-HD1700P)
AC 100–240V, 50–60 Hz (AJ-HD1700E)
Power consumption: 240W
indicates the safety information.
Operating ambient temperature:
41xF to 104xF (5xC to 40xC)
Operating ambient humidity:
10% to 80% (no condensation)
Weight:
[VIDEO]
Sampling frequencies:
Y: 74.25 MHz, Pb/Pr: 37.125 MHz
Quantizing:
Approx. 48.4 lbs (22 kg)
8 bits
Dimensions (W k H k D):
16-3/4 (max. 17-3/16 ) k 6-15/16 k 17-11/16 inches
(not including supporting feet, jacks and connectors, JOG
dial and fan)
424 (max. 435.4) k 175.2 k 448.9 mm
Recording format:
Video compression method:
DCT i variable length code
Video compression rate:
1/6.7
Error correction:
Reed-Solomon product code
Video recording bit rate:
100 Mbps
DVCPRO HD-LP
Video signals recorded:
1080i (50/59.94/60 Hz switchable)
720p (59.94/60 Hz switchable)
480i/59.94 Hz
576i/50 Hz (when optional board AJ-UC1700G is installed)
Audio signals recorded:
48 kHz, 16 bits, 8 channels
Recording tracks:
Video Input Connectors
HD serial digital input:
BNC k 1 (complies with SMPTE 292M standard),
BNC k 1 (active-through)
SD serial digital input (option):
BNC k 1 (complies with SMPTE 259M-C standard),
BNC k 1 (active-through)
Digital video/audio:
helical tracks
(Time code is recorded in sub-code area.)
Cue track:
1 track
Control track:
1 track
SDTI input (option):
BNC k 1 (complies with SMPTE 305M/SMPTE 321M
standards)*
HD reference input:
BNC k 2 (loop-through), 75™ ON/OFF selectable
SD reference input:
Tape speed:
67.64 mm/sec. (in 59.94 Hz mode)
67.70 mm/sec. (in 60 or 50 Hz mode)
Tape used:
Metal tape
Recording time:
126 minutes (using XL cassette)
92 minutes (using L cassette)
32 minutes (using M cassette)
FF/REW time:
Approx. 1 min. 30 sec. (when XL cassette is used and
i100k or j100k speed is selected)
Search speed:
BNC k 2 (loop-through), 75™ ON/OFF selectable
Video Output Connectors
HD serial digital output:
BNC k 3 (complies with SMPTE 292M standard),
BNC k 1 (monitor output with superimposed display)
SD serial digital output:
BNC k 1 (complies with SMPTE 259M-C/SMPTE 294M
standards),
BNC k 1 (monitor output with superimposed display)
SDTI output (option):
BNC k 1 (complies with SMPTE 305M/SMPTE 321M
standards)
HD reference output:
BNC k 1
SD reference output:
BNC k 1
Analog composite output:
BNC k 3, VIDEO 1, VIDEO 2 (WFM OUT), VIDEO 3
(superimposed ON/OFF), output during SD playback or
during down-conversion
d100k
Digital slow:
j1k to i2k (when playing back tapes recorded using the
DVCPRO HD-LP format)
j1k to i1.1k (when playing back tapes recorded using
any other format)
Editing accuracy:
d0 frames (when time code is used, in 50 Hz, 59.94 Hz or
60 Hz mode)
Tape timer accuracy:
d1 frame (when continuous CTL signal is used)
Servo lock time:
Less than 0.3 sec. (from standby ON)
* The optional AJ-UC1700G SD serial digital input board and
optional AJ-YAC150P SDTI input board cannot be installed at
the same time. Install one or the other.
130
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Specifications
[VIDEO]
[AUDIO]
Video signal adjustment ranges
• Component style
Cue Track
Frequency response:
300 Hz to 6 kHz w3 dB
HD/SD SDI, composite output Y gain:
j¶ to i 3 dB
HD/SD SDI, composite output Pb gain:
j¶ to i 3 dB
Audio Input Connectors
Analog input (CH1 to CH4)
HD/SD SDI, composite output Pr gain:
j¶ to i 3 dB
XLR k 4, 600™/high impedance (selectable), i4, 0, j20
dBu selectable
HD/SD SDI, composite output Y black level:
w10%
Digital input (CH1/CH2, CH3/CH4, CH5/CH6, CH7/CH8)
BNC k 4, AES/EBU format
• Composite style
HD serial digital input
HD/SD SDI, composite output video gain:
j¶ to i 6 dB
BNC k 1 (complies with SMPTE 292M/SMPTE 299M
standards)
HD/SD SDI, composite output chroma gain:
j¶ to i 3 dB
HD/SD SDI, composite output chroma phase (* ):
w30x
BNC k 1 (active-through)
SD serial digital input (option)
BNC k 1 (complies with SMPTE 259M-C/SMPTE 272M-A
standards)
1
HD/SD SDI, composite output Y setup:
w10%
BNC k 1 (active-through)
Cue track input
• System phase
XLR k 1, 600™/high impedance (selectable), i4, 0, j20,
j60 dBu selectable
HD SDI output system phase
w5.5 H (w12100 sample, 13.5 nS step, 59/60Hz)
(w14520 sample, 50/25Hz)
Audio output Connectors
Analog output (CH1 to CH4)
XLR k 4, low impedance, i4, 0, j20 dBu selectable
Digital output (CH1/CH2, CH3/CH4, CH5/CH6, CH7/CH8)
BNC k 4, AES/EBU format
(w15125 sample, 23/24Hz)
SD SDI output system phase
w5.5 H (w9438 sample, 480i: 37nS step,
480p: 54nS step)
(w9504 sample, 576i)
HD serial digital output
Composite video output system phase
w5.5 H (w9438 sample, 37nS step, 59Hz)
(w9504 sample, 37nS step, 50Hz)
Composite video output SC phase:
w180x or more
BNC k 4 (complies with SMPTE 292M/SMPTE 299M
standards)
SD serial digital output
BNC k 2 (complies with SMPTE 259M-C/SMPTE
294M/SMPTE 272M-A standards)
Cue track output
XLR k 1, low impedance (selectable), i4, 0, j20 dBu
selectable
*1: Only the SD SDI composite output of SD tape playback is valid
in the 50 Hz or 25 Hz mode.
Monitor output
XLR k 2, low impedance (selectable), i4, 0, j20 dBu
selectable
[AUDIO]
Headphone output
1/4-inch phone (6.5 mm), 8™, variable level
Digital Audio
Sampling frequency:
48 kHz (synchronized with video)
Quantizing:
Audio level adjustment range
j¶ to i 12 dB
16 bits
Frequency response:
20 Hz to 20 kHz w10 dB (at reference level)
Dynamic range:
Better than 90 dB (1 kHz, emphasis OFF)
Distortion:
Less than 0.05% (1 kHz, emphasis OFF, reference level)
Crosstalk:
Less than j80 dB (1 kHz, between 2 channels)
Wow & flutter:
Below measurable limit
Headroom:
20 dB (AJ-HD1700P)
18 dB (AJ-HD1700E)
131
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Specifications
[OTHER INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNALS]
Time code input
XLR k 1, 0.5 to 8.0 Vp-p, 10 k™
Time code output
XLR k 1, low impedance
2.0 w0.5 Vp-p, (with 600™ load)
RS-422A input
D-sub 9-pin, RS-422A interface
RS-422A output
D-sub 9-pin, RS-422A interface
RS-232C
D-sub 25-pin, RS-232C interface
Parallel input/output
D-sub 50-pin
Encoder remote
D-sub 15-pin
[OPTIONAL ACCESSORIES]
Rack-mounting adapters:
AJ-MA75P
SD-HD format converter board:
AJ-UC1700G
Encoder/decoder board supporting DVCPRO HD bank
data:
AJ-VNC150P
SDTI interface board:
AJ-YAC150P
Weight and dimensions shown are approximate.
Specifications are subject to change without notice.
132
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
133
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
PANASONIC BROADCAST & TELEVISION SYSTEMS COMPANY
UNIT COMPANY OF MATSUSHITA ELECTRIC CORPORATION OF AMERICA
Executive Office:
One Panasonic Way 4E-7, Secaucus, NJ 07094 (201) 348-7000
EASTERN ZONE:
One Panasonic Way 4E-7, Secaucus, NJ 07094 (201) 348-7621
Southeast Region:
1225 Northbrook Parkway, Ste 1-160, Suwanee, GA 30024 (770) 338-6835
Central Region:
1707 N Randall Road E1-C-1, Elgin, IL 60123 (847) 468-5200
WESTERN ZONE:
3330 Cahuenga Blvd W., Los Angeles, CA 90068 (323) 436-3500
Government Marketing Department:
52 West Gude Drive, Rockville, MD 20850 (301) 738-3840
Broadcast PARTS INFORMATION & ORDERING:
9:00 a.m. – 5:00 p.m. (EST) (800) 334-4881/24 Hr. Fax (800) 334-4880
Emergency after hour parts orders (800) 334-4881
TECHNICAL SUPPORT:
Emergency 24 Hour Service (800) 222-0741
Panasonic Canada Inc.
5770 Ambler Drive, Mississauga, Ontario L4W 2T3 (905) 624-5010
Panasonic de Mexico S.A. de C.V.
Av angel Urraza Num. 1209 Col. de Valle 03100 Mexico, D.F. (52) 1 951 2127
Panasonic Sales Company
Division of Matsushita Electric of Puerto Rico Inc.
San Gabriel Industrial Park, 65th Infantry Ave., Km. 9.5, Carolina, Puerto Rico 00630 (787) 750-4300
Panasonic Broadcast Europe
Panasonic Broadcast Europe Ltd
West Forest Gate, Wellington Road, Wokingham, Berkshire RG40 2AQ U.K. Tel: 0118 902 9200
Panasonic Broadcast Europe GmbH
Hagenauer Str. 43, 65203 Wiesbaden-Biebrich Deutschland Tel: 49-611-1816-0
@ 32
F0703H1
Printed in Japan
C 2003 Matsushita Electric Industrial Co., Ltd. All rights reserved.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
|